* xterm.h, xterm.c (x_uncatch_errors): Delete unneccessary
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
3 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
20 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
24
25 #include <config.h>
26
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
30
31 #include <stdio.h>
32
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
34
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
37
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
41
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
46
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
52
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
56
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
59
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
69
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
88
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
92
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
99
100 #ifdef USE_GTK
101 #include "gtkutil.h"
102 #endif
103
104 #ifdef USE_LUCID
105 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
106 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
107 #endif
108
109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
110
111 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
112 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
113 int));
114 #endif
115
116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
117 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 #define HACK_EDITRES
119 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
120 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
121
122 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
123
124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
125 #if defined USE_MOTIF
126 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
127 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
128 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
129
130 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
133 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
134 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
135 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
136 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
137 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
138 #ifndef XtNpickTop
139 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
140 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
141 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
142 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
143
144 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
145
146 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
147 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
148 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
149 #endif
150
151 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
152 #include "widget.h"
153 #ifndef XtNinitialState
154 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
155 #endif
156 #endif
157
158 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
159
160 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
161 #ifdef USE_XIM
162 int use_xim = 1;
163 #else
164 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
165 #endif
166
167 \f
168
169 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
170
171 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
172
173 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
174 start. */
175
176 static int any_help_event_p;
177
178 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
179 static Lisp_Object last_window;
180
181 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
182
183 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
184
185 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
186 use. */
187
188 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
189
190 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
191 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
192 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
193 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
194
195 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
196
197 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
198 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
199 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
200 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
201
202 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
203
204 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
205
206 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
207
208 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
209 /* The application context for Xt use. */
210 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
211 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
212 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
213
214 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
215
216 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
217
218 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
219 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
220
221 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
222
223 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
224 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
225 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
226
227 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
228
229 /* Mouse movement.
230
231 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
232 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
233 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
234 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
235
236 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
237
238 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
239 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
240 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
241 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
242 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
243 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
244 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
245 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
246 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
247 is off. */
248
249 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
250
251 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
252 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
253 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
254
255 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
256
257 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
258 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
259 an ordinary motion.
260
261 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
262 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
263 event. */
264
265 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
266
267 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
268 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
269 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
270 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
271 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
272 it's somewhat accurate. */
273
274 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
275
276 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
277 events. */
278
279 #ifdef __STDC__
280 static int volatile input_signal_count;
281 #else
282 static int input_signal_count;
283 #endif
284
285 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
286
287 static int x_noop_count;
288
289 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
290
291 extern char **initial_argv;
292 extern int initial_argc;
293
294 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
295
296 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
297
298 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
299
300 extern Lisp_Object Qeql;
301
302 extern int errno;
303
304 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
305
306 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
307
308 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
309
310 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
311 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
312 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
313
314 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
315 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
316
317 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
318 extern int x_bitmap_mask P_ ((FRAME_PTR, int));
319
320 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
321 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
322 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
323 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
324 void x_delete_display P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
325
326 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
327 void x_catch_errors P_ ((Display *));
328 void x_uncatch_errors P_ ((void));
329 void x_lower_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
330 void x_scroll_bar_clear P_ ((struct frame *));
331 int x_had_errors_p P_ ((Display *));
332 void x_wm_set_size_hint P_ ((struct frame *, long, int));
333 void x_raise_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
334 void x_set_window_size P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
335 void x_wm_set_window_state P_ ((struct frame *, int));
336 void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap P_ ((struct frame *, int));
337 void x_initialize P_ ((void));
338 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
339 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
340 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
341 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
342 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
343 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
344 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
345 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
346 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
347 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
348 static void x_focus_changed P_ ((int, int, struct x_display_info *,
349 struct frame *, struct input_event *));
350 static void x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
351 XEvent *, struct input_event *));
352 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
353 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
354 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
355 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
356 enum text_cursor_kinds));
357
358 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC));
359 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
360 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
361 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
362 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
363 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Display *, Window));
364 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
365 enum scroll_bar_part *,
366 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
367 unsigned long *));
368 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
369 static void x_check_expected_move P_ ((struct frame *));
370 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
371 int *, struct input_event *));
372
373
374 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
375
376 static void
377 x_flush (f)
378 struct frame *f;
379 {
380 BLOCK_INPUT;
381 if (f == NULL)
382 {
383 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
384 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
385 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
386 }
387 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
388 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
389 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
390 }
391
392
393 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
394 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
395 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
396 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
397 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
398 performance. */
399
400 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
401
402 \f
403 /***********************************************************************
404 Debugging
405 ***********************************************************************/
406
407 #if 0
408
409 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
410 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
411
412 struct record
413 {
414 char *locus;
415 int type;
416 };
417
418 struct record event_record[100];
419
420 int event_record_index;
421
422 record_event (locus, type)
423 char *locus;
424 int type;
425 {
426 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
427 event_record_index = 0;
428
429 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
430 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
431 event_record_index++;
432 }
433
434 #endif /* 0 */
435
436
437 \f
438 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
439
440 struct x_display_info *
441 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
442 Display *dpy;
443 {
444 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
445
446 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
447 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
448 return dpyinfo;
449
450 return 0;
451 }
452
453
454 \f
455 /***********************************************************************
456 Starting and ending an update
457 ***********************************************************************/
458
459 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
460 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
461 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
462 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
463 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
464
465 static void
466 x_update_begin (f)
467 struct frame *f;
468 {
469 /* Nothing to do. */
470 }
471
472
473 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
474 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
475 position of W. */
476
477 static void
478 x_update_window_begin (w)
479 struct window *w;
480 {
481 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
482 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
483
484 updated_window = w;
485 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
486
487 BLOCK_INPUT;
488
489 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
490 {
491 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
492 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
493
494 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
495 highlighting. */
496 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
497 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
498
499 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
500 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
501 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
502 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
503 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
504 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
505
506 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
507 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
508 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
509 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
510 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
511 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
512 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
513 {
514 int i;
515
516 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
517 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
518 break;
519
520 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
521 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
522 }
523 #endif /* 0 */
524 }
525
526 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
527 }
528
529
530 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
531
532 static void
533 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
534 struct window *w;
535 int x, y0, y1;
536 {
537 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
538 struct face *face;
539
540 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
541 if (face)
542 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
543 face->foreground);
544
545 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
546 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
547 }
548
549 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
550
551 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
552 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
553
554 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
555 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
556 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
557
558 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
559 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
560 here. */
561
562 static void
563 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
564 struct window *w;
565 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
566 {
567 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
568
569 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
570 {
571 BLOCK_INPUT;
572
573 if (cursor_on_p)
574 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
575 output_cursor.vpos,
576 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
577
578 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
579 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
580
581 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
582 }
583
584 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
585 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
586 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
587 {
588 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
589 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
590 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
591 }
592
593 updated_window = NULL;
594 }
595
596
597 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
598 update_end. */
599
600 static void
601 x_update_end (f)
602 struct frame *f;
603 {
604 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
605 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
606
607 #ifndef XFlush
608 BLOCK_INPUT;
609 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
610 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
611 #endif
612 }
613
614
615 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
616 complete update has been performed. The global variable
617 updated_window is not available here. */
618
619 static void
620 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
621 struct frame *f;
622 {
623 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
624 {
625 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
626
627 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
628 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
629 {
630 BLOCK_INPUT;
631 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
632 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
633 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
634 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
635 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
636 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
637 }
638 }
639 }
640
641
642 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
643 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
644 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
645 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
646 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
647 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
648
649 static void
650 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
651 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
652 {
653 struct window *w = updated_window;
654 struct frame *f;
655 int width, height;
656
657 xassert (w);
658
659 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
660 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
661
662 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
663 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
664 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
665 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
666 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
667 overhead is very small. */
668 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
669 && desired_row->full_width_p
670 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
671 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
672 width != 0)
673 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
674 height > 0))
675 {
676 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
677
678 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
679 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
680 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
681 y -= width;
682
683 BLOCK_INPUT;
684 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
685 0, y, width, height, False);
686 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
687 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
688 y, width, height, False);
689 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
690 }
691 }
692
693 static void
694 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
695 struct window *w;
696 struct glyph_row *row;
697 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
698 {
699 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
700 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
701 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
702 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
703 struct face *face = p->face;
704 int rowY;
705
706 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
707 rowY = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
708 if (p->y < rowY)
709 {
710 /* Adjust position of "bottom aligned" bitmap on partially
711 visible last row. */
712 int oldY = row->y;
713 int oldVH = row->visible_height;
714 row->visible_height = p->h;
715 row->y -= rowY - p->y;
716 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
717 row->y = oldY;
718 row->visible_height = oldVH;
719 }
720 else
721 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
722
723 if (p->bx >= 0 && !p->overlay_p)
724 {
725 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
726 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
727 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
728 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
729 if (face->stipple)
730 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
731 else
732 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
733
734 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
735 p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
736
737 if (!face->stipple)
738 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
739 }
740
741 if (p->which)
742 {
743 unsigned char *bits;
744 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
745 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
746 XGCValues gcv;
747
748 if (p->wd > 8)
749 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
750 else
751 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
752
753 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
754 by the server. */
755 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
756 (p->cursor_p
757 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
758 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
759 : face->foreground),
760 face->background, depth);
761
762 if (p->overlay_p)
763 {
764 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
765 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
766 bits, p->wd, p->h,
767 1, 0, 1);
768 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
769 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
770 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
771 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
772 }
773
774 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
775 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
776 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
777
778 if (p->overlay_p)
779 {
780 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
781 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
782 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
783 }
784 }
785
786 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
787 }
788
789 \f
790
791 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
792 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
793 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
794 rarely happens). */
795
796 static void
797 XTset_terminal_modes ()
798 {
799 }
800
801 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
802 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
803
804 static void
805 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
806 {
807 }
808
809
810 \f
811 /***********************************************************************
812 Display Iterator
813 ***********************************************************************/
814
815 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
816
817 static int x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *, int *));
818
819
820 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
821 is not contained in the font. */
822
823 static XCharStruct *
824 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b, font_type)
825 XFontStruct *font;
826 XChar2b *char2b;
827 int font_type; /* unused on X */
828 {
829 /* The result metric information. */
830 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
831
832 xassert (font && char2b);
833
834 if (font->per_char != NULL)
835 {
836 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
837 {
838 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
839 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
840 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
841 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
842 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
843 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
844 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
845 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
846 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
847 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
848 }
849 else
850 {
851 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
852 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
853 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
854 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
855
856 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
857 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
858
859 where:
860
861 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
862 / = integer division
863 \ = integer modulus */
864 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
865 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
866 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
867 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
868 {
869 pcm = (font->per_char
870 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
871 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
872 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
873 }
874 }
875 }
876 else
877 {
878 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
879 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
880 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
881 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
882 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
883 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
884 }
885
886 return ((pcm == NULL
887 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
888 ? NULL : pcm);
889 }
890
891
892 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
893 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
894
895 static int
896 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info, two_byte_p)
897 int c;
898 XChar2b *char2b;
899 struct font_info *font_info;
900 int *two_byte_p;
901 {
902 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
903 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
904
905 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
906 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
907 fixed encoding. */
908 if (font_info->font_encoder)
909 {
910 /* It's a program. */
911 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
912
913 check_ccl_update (ccl);
914 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
915 {
916 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
917 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
918 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
919 }
920 else
921 {
922 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
923 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
924 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
925 }
926
927 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
928
929 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
930 program. */
931 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
932 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
933 else
934 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
935 }
936 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
937 {
938 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
939 encoding numbers. */
940 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
941
942 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
943 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
944 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
945
946 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
947 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
948 }
949
950 if (two_byte_p)
951 *two_byte_p = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
952
953 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
954 }
955
956
957 \f
958 /***********************************************************************
959 Glyph display
960 ***********************************************************************/
961
962
963
964 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
965 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
966 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
967 int));
968 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
969 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
970 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
971 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
972 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
973 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
974 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
975 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
976 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
977 unsigned long *, double, int));
978 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
979 double, int, unsigned long));
980 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
981 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
982 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
983 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
984 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
985 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
986 int, int, int));
987 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
988 int, int, int, int, int, int,
989 XRectangle *));
990 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
991 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
992
993 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
994 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
995 #endif
996
997
998 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
999 face. */
1000
1001 static void
1002 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
1003 struct glyph_string *s;
1004 {
1005 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
1006 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1007 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1008 && !s->cmp)
1009 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
1010 else
1011 {
1012 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
1013 XGCValues xgcv;
1014 unsigned long mask;
1015
1016 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
1017 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1018
1019 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
1020 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1021 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1022 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1023 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
1024 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1025 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1026
1027 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1028 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
1029 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
1030 {
1031 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
1032 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1033 }
1034
1035 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1036 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1037 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1038 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1039
1040 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1041 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1042 mask, &xgcv);
1043 else
1044 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1045 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1046
1047 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1048 }
1049 }
1050
1051
1052 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1053
1054 static void
1055 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1056 struct glyph_string *s;
1057 {
1058 int face_id;
1059 struct face *face;
1060
1061 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1062 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1063 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1064 if (face == NULL)
1065 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1066
1067 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1068 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
1069 else
1070 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
1071 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1072 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1073
1074 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1075 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1076 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1077 else
1078 {
1079 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1080 but font FONT. */
1081 XGCValues xgcv;
1082 unsigned long mask;
1083
1084 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1085 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1086 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1087 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1088 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1089 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1090
1091 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1092 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1093 mask, &xgcv);
1094 else
1095 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1096 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1097
1098 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1099 }
1100
1101 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1102 }
1103
1104
1105 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1106 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1107 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1108
1109 static INLINE void
1110 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1111 struct glyph_string *s;
1112 {
1113 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1114 }
1115
1116
1117 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1118 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1119 pattern. */
1120
1121 static INLINE void
1122 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1123 struct glyph_string *s;
1124 {
1125 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1126
1127 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1128 {
1129 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1130 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1131 }
1132 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1133 {
1134 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1135 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1136 }
1137 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1138 {
1139 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1140 s->stippled_p = 0;
1141 }
1142 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1143 {
1144 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1145 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1146 }
1147 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1148 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1149 {
1150 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1151 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1152 }
1153 else
1154 {
1155 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1156 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1157 }
1158
1159 /* GC must have been set. */
1160 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1161 }
1162
1163
1164 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1165 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1166
1167 static INLINE void
1168 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1169 struct glyph_string *s;
1170 {
1171 XRectangle r;
1172 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
1173 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1174 }
1175
1176
1177 /* RIF:
1178 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
1179 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
1180
1181 static void
1182 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1183 struct glyph_string *s;
1184 {
1185 if (s->cmp == NULL
1186 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1187 {
1188 XCharStruct cs;
1189 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
1190 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
1191 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
1192 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
1193 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
1194 }
1195 }
1196
1197
1198 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1199
1200 static INLINE void
1201 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1202 struct glyph_string *s;
1203 int x, y, w, h;
1204 {
1205 XGCValues xgcv;
1206 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1207 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1208 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1209 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1210 }
1211
1212
1213 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1214 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1215 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1216 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1217 contains the first component of a composition. */
1218
1219 static void
1220 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1221 struct glyph_string *s;
1222 int force_p;
1223 {
1224 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1225 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1226 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1227 {
1228 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1229
1230 if (s->stippled_p)
1231 {
1232 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1233 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1234 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1235 s->y + box_line_width,
1236 s->background_width,
1237 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1238 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1239 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1240 }
1241 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1242 || s->font_not_found_p
1243 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1244 || force_p)
1245 {
1246 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1247 s->background_width,
1248 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1249 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1250 }
1251 }
1252 }
1253
1254
1255 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1256
1257 static void
1258 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1259 struct glyph_string *s;
1260 {
1261 int i, x;
1262
1263 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1264 of S to the right of that box line. */
1265 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1266 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1267 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1268 else
1269 x = s->x;
1270
1271 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1272 loaded. */
1273 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1274 {
1275 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1276 {
1277 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1278 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1279 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1280 s->height - 1);
1281 x += g->pixel_width;
1282 }
1283 }
1284 else
1285 {
1286 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
1287 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1288
1289 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1290 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1291
1292 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1293 if (!s->two_byte_p)
1294 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1295 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
1296
1297 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1298 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1299 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1300 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1301 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1302 if (s->for_overlaps
1303 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1304 {
1305 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1306 if (s->two_byte_p)
1307 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1308 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1309 else
1310 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1311 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1312 }
1313 else
1314 {
1315 if (s->two_byte_p)
1316 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1317 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1318 else
1319 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1320 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1321 }
1322
1323 if (s->face->overstrike)
1324 {
1325 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1326 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1327 if (s->two_byte_p)
1328 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1329 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1330 else
1331 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1332 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1333 }
1334 }
1335 }
1336
1337 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1338
1339 static void
1340 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1341 struct glyph_string *s;
1342 {
1343 int i, x;
1344
1345 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1346 of S to the right of that box line. */
1347 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1348 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1349 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1350 else
1351 x = s->x;
1352
1353 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1354 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1355 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1356 this composition. */
1357
1358 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1359 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1360 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1361 {
1362 if (s->gidx == 0)
1363 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1364 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1365 }
1366 else
1367 {
1368 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
1369 {
1370 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1371 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
1372 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1373 s->char2b + i, 1);
1374 if (s->face->overstrike)
1375 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1376 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2] + 1,
1377 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1378 s->char2b + i, 1);
1379 }
1380 }
1381 }
1382
1383
1384 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1385
1386 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1387 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1388 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1389 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1390 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1391
1392
1393 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1394 cannot be determined. */
1395
1396 static struct frame *
1397 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1398 Widget widget;
1399 {
1400 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1401 Lisp_Object tail;
1402 struct frame *f;
1403
1404 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1405
1406 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1407 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1408 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1409 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1410 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1411 widget = XtParent (widget);
1412
1413 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1414 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1415 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1416 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1417 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1418 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
1419 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1420 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1421 return f;
1422
1423 abort ();
1424 }
1425
1426
1427 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1428 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1429 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1430 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1431
1432 int
1433 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1434 Widget widget;
1435 Colormap cmap;
1436 XColor *color;
1437 {
1438 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1439 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1440 }
1441
1442
1443 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1444 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1445 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1446 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1447 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1448 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1449
1450 int
1451 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1452 Widget widget;
1453 Display *display;
1454 Colormap cmap;
1455 unsigned long *pixel;
1456 double factor;
1457 int delta;
1458 {
1459 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1460 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1461 }
1462
1463
1464 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1465 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1466
1467 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1468 {
1469 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1470 sizeof (Screen *)},
1471 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1472 sizeof (Colormap)}
1473 };
1474
1475
1476 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1477 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1478
1479 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1480
1481
1482 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1483
1484 DPY is the display we are working on.
1485
1486 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1487 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1488 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1489 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1490
1491 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1492 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1493
1494 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1495 we allocated the color or not.
1496
1497 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1498
1499 static Boolean
1500 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1501 Display *dpy;
1502 XrmValue *args;
1503 Cardinal *nargs;
1504 XrmValue *from, *to;
1505 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1506 {
1507 Screen *screen;
1508 Colormap cmap;
1509 Pixel pixel;
1510 String color_name;
1511 XColor color;
1512
1513 if (*nargs != 2)
1514 {
1515 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1516 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1517 "XtToolkitError",
1518 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1519 return False;
1520 }
1521
1522 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1523 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1524 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1525
1526 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1527 {
1528 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1529 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1530 }
1531 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1532 {
1533 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1534 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1535 }
1536 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1537 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1538 {
1539 pixel = color.pixel;
1540 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1541 }
1542 else
1543 {
1544 String params[1];
1545 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1546
1547 params[0] = color_name;
1548 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1549 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1550 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1551 params, &nparams);
1552 return False;
1553 }
1554
1555 if (to->addr != NULL)
1556 {
1557 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1558 {
1559 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1560 return False;
1561 }
1562
1563 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1564 }
1565 else
1566 {
1567 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1568 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1569 }
1570
1571 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1572 return True;
1573 }
1574
1575
1576 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1577 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1578 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1579
1580 APP is the application context in which we work.
1581
1582 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1583 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1584 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1585
1586 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1587
1588 static void
1589 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1590 XtAppContext app;
1591 XrmValuePtr to;
1592 XtPointer closure;
1593 XrmValuePtr args;
1594 Cardinal *nargs;
1595 {
1596 if (*nargs != 2)
1597 {
1598 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1599 "XtToolkitError",
1600 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1601 NULL, NULL);
1602 }
1603 else if (closure != NULL)
1604 {
1605 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1606 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1607 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1608 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1609 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1610 }
1611 }
1612
1613
1614 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1615
1616
1617 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1618 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1619 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1620 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1621
1622 static const XColor *
1623 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1624 Display *dpy;
1625 int *ncells;
1626 {
1627 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1628
1629 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1630 {
1631 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1632 int i;
1633
1634 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1635 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1636 dpyinfo->color_cells
1637 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1638 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1639
1640 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1641 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1642
1643 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1644 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1645 }
1646
1647 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1648 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1649 }
1650
1651
1652 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1653 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1654
1655 void
1656 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1657 struct frame *f;
1658 XColor *colors;
1659 int ncolors;
1660 {
1661 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1662
1663 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1664 {
1665 int i;
1666 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1667 {
1668 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1669 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1670 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1671 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1672 }
1673 }
1674 else
1675 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1676 }
1677
1678
1679 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1680 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1681
1682 void
1683 x_query_color (f, color)
1684 struct frame *f;
1685 XColor *color;
1686 {
1687 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1688 }
1689
1690
1691 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1692 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1693 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1694 allocated. */
1695
1696 static int
1697 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1698 Display *dpy;
1699 Colormap cmap;
1700 XColor *color;
1701 {
1702 int rc;
1703
1704 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1705 if (rc == 0)
1706 {
1707 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1708 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1709 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1710 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1711 int nearest, i;
1712 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1713 int ncells;
1714 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1715
1716 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1717 {
1718 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1719 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1720 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1721 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1722
1723 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1724 {
1725 nearest = i;
1726 nearest_delta = delta;
1727 }
1728 }
1729
1730 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1731 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1732 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1733 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1734 }
1735 else
1736 {
1737 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1738 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1739 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1740 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1741 XColor *cached_color;
1742
1743 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1744 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1745 (cached_color->red != color->red
1746 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1747 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1748 {
1749 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1750 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1751 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1752 }
1753 }
1754
1755 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1756 if (rc)
1757 register_color (color->pixel);
1758 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1759
1760 return rc;
1761 }
1762
1763
1764 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1765 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1766 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1767 allocated. */
1768
1769 int
1770 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1771 struct frame *f;
1772 Colormap cmap;
1773 XColor *color;
1774 {
1775 gamma_correct (f, color);
1776 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1777 }
1778
1779
1780 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1781 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1782 get color reference counts right. */
1783
1784 unsigned long
1785 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
1786 struct frame *f;
1787 unsigned long pixel;
1788 {
1789 XColor color;
1790
1791 color.pixel = pixel;
1792 BLOCK_INPUT;
1793 x_query_color (f, &color);
1794 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1795 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1796 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1797 register_color (pixel);
1798 #endif
1799 return color.pixel;
1800 }
1801
1802
1803 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1804 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1805 get color reference counts right. */
1806
1807 unsigned long
1808 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
1809 Display *dpy;
1810 Colormap cmap;
1811 unsigned long pixel;
1812 {
1813 XColor color;
1814
1815 color.pixel = pixel;
1816 BLOCK_INPUT;
1817 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1818 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1819 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1820 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1821 register_color (pixel);
1822 #endif
1823 return color.pixel;
1824 }
1825
1826
1827 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1828 boosted.
1829
1830 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1831 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1832 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1833 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1834 use an additional additive factor.
1835
1836 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1837 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1838 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1839
1840
1841 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1842 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1843 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1844 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1845 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1846 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1847
1848 static int
1849 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1850 struct frame *f;
1851 Display *display;
1852 Colormap cmap;
1853 unsigned long *pixel;
1854 double factor;
1855 int delta;
1856 {
1857 XColor color, new;
1858 long bright;
1859 int success_p;
1860
1861 /* Get RGB color values. */
1862 color.pixel = *pixel;
1863 x_query_color (f, &color);
1864
1865 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1866 xassert (factor >= 0);
1867 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1868 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1869 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1870
1871 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1872 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1873
1874 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1875 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1876 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1877 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1878 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1879 {
1880 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1881 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1882 /* The additive adjustment. */
1883 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1884
1885 if (factor < 1)
1886 {
1887 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1888 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1889 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1890 }
1891 else
1892 {
1893 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1894 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1895 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1896 }
1897 }
1898
1899 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1900 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1901 if (success_p)
1902 {
1903 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1904 {
1905 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1906 delta to the RGB values. */
1907 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1908
1909 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1910 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1911 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1912 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1913 }
1914 else
1915 success_p = 1;
1916 *pixel = new.pixel;
1917 }
1918
1919 return success_p;
1920 }
1921
1922
1923 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1924 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1925 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1926 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1927 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1928 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1929
1930 static void
1931 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
1932 struct frame *f;
1933 struct relief *relief;
1934 double factor;
1935 int delta;
1936 unsigned long default_pixel;
1937 {
1938 XGCValues xgcv;
1939 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1940 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1941 unsigned long pixel;
1942 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1943 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1944 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1945 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1946
1947 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1948 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1949
1950 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1951 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1952 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1953 if (relief->gc
1954 && relief->allocated_p)
1955 {
1956 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1957 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1958 }
1959
1960 /* Allocate new color. */
1961 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1962 pixel = background;
1963 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1964 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1965 {
1966 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1967 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1968 }
1969
1970 if (relief->gc == 0)
1971 {
1972 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1973 mask |= GCStipple;
1974 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1975 }
1976 else
1977 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1978 }
1979
1980
1981 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1982
1983 static void
1984 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
1985 struct glyph_string *s;
1986 {
1987 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1988 unsigned long color;
1989
1990 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1991 color = s->face->box_color;
1992 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1993 && s->img->pixmap
1994 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1995 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1996 else
1997 {
1998 XGCValues xgcv;
1999
2000 /* Get the background color of the face. */
2001 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
2002 color = xgcv.background;
2003 }
2004
2005 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
2006 || color != di->relief_background)
2007 {
2008 di->relief_background = color;
2009 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
2010 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2011 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
2012 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2013 }
2014 }
2015
2016
2017 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2018 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2019 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2020 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2021 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2022 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2023 when drawing. */
2024
2025 static void
2026 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2027 raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2028 struct frame *f;
2029 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width;
2030 int top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
2031 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2032 {
2033 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2034 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2035 int i;
2036 GC gc;
2037
2038 if (raised_p)
2039 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2040 else
2041 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2042 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2043
2044 /* Top. */
2045 if (top_p)
2046 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2047 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2048 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2049 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2050
2051 /* Left. */
2052 if (left_p)
2053 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2054 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2055 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2056
2057 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2058 if (raised_p)
2059 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2060 else
2061 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2062 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2063
2064 /* Bottom. */
2065 if (bot_p)
2066 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2067 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2068 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2069 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2070
2071 /* Right. */
2072 if (right_p)
2073 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2074 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2075 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2076
2077 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2078 }
2079
2080
2081 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2082 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2083 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2084 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2085 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2086 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2087
2088 static void
2089 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2090 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2091 struct glyph_string *s;
2092 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2093 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2094 {
2095 XGCValues xgcv;
2096
2097 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2098 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2099 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2100
2101 /* Top. */
2102 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2103 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2104
2105 /* Left. */
2106 if (left_p)
2107 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2108 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2109
2110 /* Bottom. */
2111 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2112 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2113
2114 /* Right. */
2115 if (right_p)
2116 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2117 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2118
2119 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2120 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2121 }
2122
2123
2124 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2125
2126 static void
2127 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2128 struct glyph_string *s;
2129 {
2130 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2131 int left_p, right_p;
2132 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2133 XRectangle clip_rect;
2134
2135 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2136 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2137 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2138
2139 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2140 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2141 ? s->first_glyph
2142 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2143
2144 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2145 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2146 left_x = s->x;
2147 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2148 ? last_x - 1
2149 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2150 top_y = s->y;
2151 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2152
2153 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2154 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2155 && (s->prev == NULL
2156 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2157 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2158 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2159 && (s->next == NULL
2160 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2161
2162 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2163
2164 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2165 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2166 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2167 else
2168 {
2169 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2170 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2171 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2172 }
2173 }
2174
2175
2176 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2177
2178 static void
2179 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2180 struct glyph_string *s;
2181 {
2182 int x = s->x;
2183 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2184
2185 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2186 right of that line. */
2187 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2188 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2189 && s->slice.x == 0)
2190 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2191
2192 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2193 by that margin. */
2194 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2195 x += s->img->hmargin;
2196 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2197 y += s->img->vmargin;
2198
2199 if (s->img->pixmap)
2200 {
2201 if (s->img->mask)
2202 {
2203 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2204 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2205 trust on the shape extension to be available
2206 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2207 manually. */
2208 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2209 | GCFunction);
2210 XGCValues xgcv;
2211 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2212
2213 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2214 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2215 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2216 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2217 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2218
2219 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2220 image_rect.x = x;
2221 image_rect.y = y;
2222 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2223 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2224 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2225 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2226 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2227 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2228 }
2229 else
2230 {
2231 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2232
2233 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2234 image_rect.x = x;
2235 image_rect.y = y;
2236 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2237 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2238 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2239 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2240 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2241 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2242
2243 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2244 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2245 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2246 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2247 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2248 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2249 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2250 {
2251 int r = s->img->relief;
2252 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2253 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2254 x - r, y - r,
2255 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2256 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2257 }
2258 }
2259 }
2260 else
2261 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2262 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2263 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2264 }
2265
2266
2267 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2268
2269 static void
2270 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2271 struct glyph_string *s;
2272 {
2273 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2274 XRectangle r;
2275 int x = s->x;
2276 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2277
2278 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2279 right of that line. */
2280 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2281 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2282 && s->slice.x == 0)
2283 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2284
2285 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2286 by that margin. */
2287 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2288 x += s->img->hmargin;
2289 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2290 y += s->img->vmargin;
2291
2292 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2293 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2294 {
2295 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2296 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2297 }
2298 else
2299 {
2300 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
2301 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2302 }
2303
2304 x0 = x - thick;
2305 y0 = y - thick;
2306 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1;
2307 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1;
2308
2309 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2310 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2311 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2312 s->slice.y == 0,
2313 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2314 s->slice.x == 0,
2315 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2316 &r);
2317 }
2318
2319
2320 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2321
2322 static void
2323 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2324 struct glyph_string *s;
2325 Pixmap pixmap;
2326 {
2327 int x = 0;
2328 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2329
2330 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2331 right of that line. */
2332 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2333 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2334 && s->slice.x == 0)
2335 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2336
2337 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2338 by that margin. */
2339 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2340 x += s->img->hmargin;
2341 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2342 y += s->img->vmargin;
2343
2344 if (s->img->pixmap)
2345 {
2346 if (s->img->mask)
2347 {
2348 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2349 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2350 trust on the shape extension to be available
2351 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2352 manually. */
2353 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2354 | GCFunction);
2355 XGCValues xgcv;
2356
2357 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2358 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2359 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2360 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2361 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2362
2363 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2364 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2365 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2366 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2367 }
2368 else
2369 {
2370 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2371 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2372 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2373
2374 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2375 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2376 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2377 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2378 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2379 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2380 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2381 {
2382 int r = s->img->relief;
2383 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2384 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2385 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2386 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2387 }
2388 }
2389 }
2390 else
2391 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2392 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2393 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2394 }
2395
2396
2397 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2398 give the rectangle to draw. */
2399
2400 static void
2401 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2402 struct glyph_string *s;
2403 int x, y, w, h;
2404 {
2405 if (s->stippled_p)
2406 {
2407 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2408 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2409 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2410 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2411 }
2412 else
2413 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2414 }
2415
2416
2417 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2418
2419 s->y
2420 s->x +-------------------------
2421 | s->face->box
2422 |
2423 | +-------------------------
2424 | | s->img->margin
2425 | |
2426 | | +-------------------
2427 | | | the image
2428
2429 */
2430
2431 static void
2432 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2433 struct glyph_string *s;
2434 {
2435 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2436 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2437 int height;
2438 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2439
2440 height = s->height;
2441 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2442 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2443 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2444 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2445
2446 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2447 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2448 flickering. */
2449 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2450 if (height > s->slice.height
2451 || s->img->hmargin
2452 || s->img->vmargin
2453 || s->img->mask
2454 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2455 || s->width != s->background_width)
2456 {
2457 if (s->img->mask)
2458 {
2459 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2460 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2461 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2462 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2463 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2464
2465 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2466 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2467 s->background_width,
2468 s->height, depth);
2469
2470 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2471 pixmap. */
2472 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2473
2474 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2475 if (s->stippled_p)
2476 {
2477 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2478 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2479 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2480 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2481 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2482 }
2483 else
2484 {
2485 XGCValues xgcv;
2486 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2487 &xgcv);
2488 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2489 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2490 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2491 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2492 }
2493 }
2494 else
2495 {
2496 int x = s->x;
2497 int y = s->y;
2498
2499 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2500 && s->slice.x == 0)
2501 x += box_line_hwidth;
2502
2503 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2504 y += box_line_vwidth;
2505
2506 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2507 }
2508
2509 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2510 }
2511
2512 /* Draw the foreground. */
2513 if (pixmap != None)
2514 {
2515 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2516 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2517 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2518 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2519 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2520 }
2521 else
2522 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2523
2524 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2525 if (s->img->relief
2526 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2527 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2528 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2529 }
2530
2531
2532 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2533
2534 static void
2535 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2536 struct glyph_string *s;
2537 {
2538 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2539 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2540
2541 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2542 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2543 {
2544 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2545 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2546 int width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), s->background_width);
2547
2548 /* Draw cursor. */
2549 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, width, s->height);
2550
2551 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2552 if (width < s->background_width)
2553 {
2554 int x = s->x + width, y = s->y;
2555 int w = s->background_width - width, h = s->height;
2556 XRectangle r;
2557 GC gc;
2558
2559 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2560 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2561 {
2562 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2563 gc = s->gc;
2564 }
2565 else
2566 gc = s->face->gc;
2567
2568 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2569 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2570
2571 if (s->face->stipple)
2572 {
2573 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2574 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2575 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2576 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2577 }
2578 else
2579 {
2580 XGCValues xgcv;
2581 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2582 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2583 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2584 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2585 }
2586 }
2587 }
2588 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2589 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, s->background_width,
2590 s->height);
2591
2592 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2593 }
2594
2595
2596 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2597
2598 static void
2599 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2600 struct glyph_string *s;
2601 {
2602 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2603
2604 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
2605 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
2606 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2607 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2608 {
2609 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
2610 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
2611 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
2612 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
2613 }
2614
2615 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2616 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2617
2618 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2619 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2620 if (!s->for_overlaps
2621 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2622 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2623 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2624
2625 {
2626 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2627 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2628 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2629 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2630 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2631 }
2632 else
2633 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2634
2635 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2636 {
2637 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2638 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2639 break;
2640
2641 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2642 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2643 break;
2644
2645 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2646 if (s->for_overlaps)
2647 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2648 else
2649 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2650 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2651 break;
2652
2653 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2654 if (s->for_overlaps || s->gidx > 0)
2655 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2656 else
2657 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2658 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2659 break;
2660
2661 default:
2662 abort ();
2663 }
2664
2665 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2666 {
2667 /* Draw underline. */
2668 if (s->face->underline_p)
2669 {
2670 unsigned long tem, h;
2671 int y;
2672
2673 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2674 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
2675 h = 1;
2676
2677 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2678 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2679 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2680 specs, and its default is
2681
2682 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2683 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2684
2685 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2686 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
2687 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
2688 else if (s->face->font)
2689 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2690 else
2691 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2692
2693 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2694 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2695 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2696 else
2697 {
2698 XGCValues xgcv;
2699 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2700 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2701 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2702 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2703 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2704 }
2705 }
2706
2707 /* Draw overline. */
2708 if (s->face->overline_p)
2709 {
2710 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2711
2712 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2713 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2714 s->width, h);
2715 else
2716 {
2717 XGCValues xgcv;
2718 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2719 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2720 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2721 s->width, h);
2722 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2723 }
2724 }
2725
2726 /* Draw strike-through. */
2727 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2728 {
2729 unsigned long h = 1;
2730 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2731
2732 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2733 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2734 s->width, h);
2735 else
2736 {
2737 XGCValues xgcv;
2738 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2739 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2740 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2741 s->width, h);
2742 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2743 }
2744 }
2745
2746 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2747 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2748 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2749 }
2750
2751 /* Reset clipping. */
2752 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2753 }
2754
2755 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2756
2757 void
2758 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
2759 struct frame *f;
2760 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
2761 {
2762 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2763 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2764 x, y, width, height,
2765 x + shift_by, y);
2766 }
2767
2768 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2769 for X frames. */
2770
2771 static void
2772 x_delete_glyphs (n)
2773 register int n;
2774 {
2775 abort ();
2776 }
2777
2778
2779 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2780 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2781
2782 void
2783 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
2784 Display *dpy;
2785 Window window;
2786 int x, y;
2787 int width, height;
2788 int exposures;
2789 {
2790 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2791 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2792 }
2793
2794
2795 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
2796 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
2797
2798 static void
2799 x_clear_frame ()
2800 {
2801 struct frame *f;
2802
2803 if (updating_frame)
2804 f = updating_frame;
2805 else
2806 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2807
2808 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2809 longer visible. */
2810 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2811 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2812 output_cursor.x = -1;
2813
2814 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2815 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2816 BLOCK_INPUT;
2817 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2818
2819 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2820 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2821 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2822
2823 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2824
2825 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2826 }
2827
2828
2829 \f
2830 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2831
2832 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2833 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2834
2835 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2836
2837
2838 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2839 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2840
2841 static int
2842 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
2843 struct timeval *result, x, y;
2844 {
2845 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2846 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2847 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2848 {
2849 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2850 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2851 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2852 }
2853
2854 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2855 {
2856 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2857 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2858 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2859 }
2860
2861 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2862 positive. */
2863 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2864 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2865
2866 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2867 negative. */
2868 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2869 }
2870
2871 void
2872 XTflash (f)
2873 struct frame *f;
2874 {
2875 BLOCK_INPUT;
2876
2877 {
2878 GC gc;
2879
2880 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2881 pixels into background pixels. */
2882 {
2883 XGCValues values;
2884
2885 values.function = GXxor;
2886 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
2887 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
2888
2889 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2890 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2891 }
2892
2893 {
2894 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2895 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2896 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2897 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2898 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2899 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2900 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2901
2902 int width;
2903
2904 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2905 edge it is next to. */
2906 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2907 {
2908 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2909 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2910 break;
2911
2912 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2913 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2914 break;
2915
2916 default:
2917 break;
2918 }
2919
2920 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2921
2922 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2923 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2924 {
2925 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2926 flash_left,
2927 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2928 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2929 width, flash_height);
2930 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2931 flash_left,
2932 (height - flash_height
2933 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2934 width, flash_height);
2935 }
2936 else
2937 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2938 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2939 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2940 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2941
2942 x_flush (f);
2943
2944 {
2945 struct timeval wakeup;
2946
2947 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
2948
2949 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
2950 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
2951 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
2952 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
2953
2954 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
2955 available. */
2956 while (! detect_input_pending ())
2957 {
2958 struct timeval current;
2959 struct timeval timeout;
2960
2961 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
2962
2963 /* Break if result would be negative. */
2964 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
2965 break;
2966
2967 /* How long `select' should wait. */
2968 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
2969 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
2970
2971 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
2972 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
2973 }
2974 }
2975
2976 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2977 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2978 {
2979 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2980 flash_left,
2981 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2982 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2983 width, flash_height);
2984 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2985 flash_left,
2986 (height - flash_height
2987 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2988 width, flash_height);
2989 }
2990 else
2991 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2992 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2993 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2994 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2995
2996 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
2997 x_flush (f);
2998 }
2999 }
3000
3001 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3002 }
3003
3004 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3005
3006
3007 /* Make audible bell. */
3008
3009 void
3010 XTring_bell ()
3011 {
3012 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3013
3014 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3015 {
3016 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3017 if (visible_bell)
3018 XTflash (f);
3019 else
3020 #endif
3021 {
3022 BLOCK_INPUT;
3023 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3024 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3025 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3026 }
3027 }
3028 }
3029
3030 \f
3031 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3032 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3033 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3034 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3035
3036 static void
3037 XTset_terminal_window (n)
3038 register int n;
3039 {
3040 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3041 }
3042
3043
3044 \f
3045 /***********************************************************************
3046 Line Dance
3047 ***********************************************************************/
3048
3049 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3050 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3051
3052 static void
3053 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
3054 int vpos, n;
3055 {
3056 abort ();
3057 }
3058
3059
3060 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3061
3062 static void
3063 x_scroll_run (w, run)
3064 struct window *w;
3065 struct run *run;
3066 {
3067 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3068 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3069
3070 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3071 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3072 fringe of W. */
3073 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3074
3075 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3076 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3077 bottom_y = y + height;
3078
3079 if (to_y < from_y)
3080 {
3081 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3082 line at the bottom. */
3083 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3084 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3085 else
3086 height = run->height;
3087 }
3088 else
3089 {
3090 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3091 at the bottom. */
3092 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3093 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3094 else
3095 height = run->height;
3096 }
3097
3098 BLOCK_INPUT;
3099
3100 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3101 updated_window = w;
3102 x_clear_cursor (w);
3103
3104 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3105 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3106 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3107 x, from_y,
3108 width, height,
3109 x, to_y);
3110
3111 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3112 }
3113
3114
3115 \f
3116 /***********************************************************************
3117 Exposure Events
3118 ***********************************************************************/
3119
3120 \f
3121 static void
3122 frame_highlight (f)
3123 struct frame *f;
3124 {
3125 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3126 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3127 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3128 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3129 BLOCK_INPUT;
3130 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3131 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3132 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3133 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3134 }
3135
3136 static void
3137 frame_unhighlight (f)
3138 struct frame *f;
3139 {
3140 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3141 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3142 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3143 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3144 BLOCK_INPUT;
3145 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3146 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3147 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3148 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3149 }
3150
3151 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3152 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3153 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3154 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3155 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3156
3157 static void
3158 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3159 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3160 struct frame *frame;
3161 {
3162 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3163
3164 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3165 {
3166 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3167 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3168 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3169
3170 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3171 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3172
3173 #if 0
3174 selected_frame = frame;
3175 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
3176 selected_frame);
3177 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window, Qnil);
3178 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3179 #endif /* ! 0 */
3180
3181 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3182 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3183 else
3184 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3185 }
3186
3187 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3188 }
3189
3190 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3191 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3192 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3193
3194 static void
3195 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp)
3196 int type;
3197 int state;
3198 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3199 struct frame *frame;
3200 struct input_event *bufp;
3201 {
3202 if (type == FocusIn)
3203 {
3204 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3205 {
3206 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3207 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3208
3209 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3210 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3211 if (GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3212 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
3213 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3214 {
3215 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3216 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3217 }
3218 }
3219
3220 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3221
3222 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3223 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3224 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3225 #endif
3226 }
3227 else if (type == FocusOut)
3228 {
3229 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3230
3231 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3232 {
3233 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3234 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3235 }
3236
3237 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3238 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3239 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3240 #endif
3241 }
3242 }
3243
3244 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3245 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3246
3247 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3248
3249 static void
3250 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp)
3251 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3252 XEvent *event;
3253 struct input_event *bufp;
3254 {
3255 struct frame *frame;
3256
3257 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3258 if (! frame)
3259 return;
3260
3261 switch (event->type)
3262 {
3263 case EnterNotify:
3264 case LeaveNotify:
3265 {
3266 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3267 int focus_state
3268 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3269
3270 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3271 && event->xcrossing.focus
3272 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3273 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3274 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3275 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3276 }
3277 break;
3278
3279 case FocusIn:
3280 case FocusOut:
3281 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3282 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3283 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3284 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3285 break;
3286 }
3287 }
3288
3289
3290 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3291
3292 void
3293 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3294 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3295 {
3296 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3297 }
3298
3299 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3300 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3301 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3302
3303 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3304 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3305 the appropriate X display info. */
3306
3307 static void
3308 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3309 struct frame *frame;
3310 {
3311 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3312 }
3313
3314 static void
3315 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3316 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3317 {
3318 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3319
3320 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3321 {
3322 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3323 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3324 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3325 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3326 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3327 {
3328 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3329 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3330 }
3331 }
3332 else
3333 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3334
3335 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3336 {
3337 if (old_highlight)
3338 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3339 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3340 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3341 }
3342 }
3343
3344
3345 \f
3346 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3347
3348 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3349 static void
3350 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3351 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3352 {
3353 int min_code, max_code;
3354 KeySym *syms;
3355 int syms_per_code;
3356 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3357
3358 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3359 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3360 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3361 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3362 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3363
3364 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
3365 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3366 #else
3367 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
3368 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
3369 #endif
3370
3371 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3372 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3373 &syms_per_code);
3374 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3375
3376 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3377 Alt keysyms are on. */
3378 {
3379 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3380 int found_alt_or_meta;
3381
3382 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3383 {
3384 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3385 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3386 {
3387 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3388
3389 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3390 if (code == 0)
3391 continue;
3392
3393 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3394 {
3395 int code_col;
3396
3397 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3398 {
3399 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3400
3401 switch (sym)
3402 {
3403 case XK_Meta_L:
3404 case XK_Meta_R:
3405 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3406 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3407 break;
3408
3409 case XK_Alt_L:
3410 case XK_Alt_R:
3411 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3412 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3413 break;
3414
3415 case XK_Hyper_L:
3416 case XK_Hyper_R:
3417 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3418 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3419 code_col = syms_per_code;
3420 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3421 break;
3422
3423 case XK_Super_L:
3424 case XK_Super_R:
3425 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3426 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3427 code_col = syms_per_code;
3428 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3429 break;
3430
3431 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3432 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3433 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3434 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3435 code_col = syms_per_code;
3436 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3437 break;
3438 }
3439 }
3440 }
3441 }
3442 }
3443 }
3444
3445 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3446 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3447 {
3448 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3449 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3450 }
3451
3452 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3453 make them just meta, not alt. */
3454 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3455 {
3456 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3457 }
3458
3459 XFree ((char *) syms);
3460 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3461 }
3462
3463 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3464 Emacs uses. */
3465
3466 unsigned int
3467 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3468 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3469 unsigned int state;
3470 {
3471 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3472 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3473 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3474 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3475 Lisp_Object tem;
3476
3477 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3478 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3479 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3480 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3481 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3482 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3483 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3484 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3485
3486
3487 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3488 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3489 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3490 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3491 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3492 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3493 }
3494
3495 static unsigned int
3496 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3497 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3498 unsigned int state;
3499 {
3500 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3501 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3502 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3503 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3504
3505 Lisp_Object tem;
3506
3507 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3508 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3509 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3510 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3511 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3512 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3513 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3514 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3515
3516
3517 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3518 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3519 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3520 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3521 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3522 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3523 }
3524
3525 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3526
3527 char *
3528 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3529 KeySym keysym;
3530 {
3531 char *value;
3532
3533 BLOCK_INPUT;
3534 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3535 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3536
3537 return value;
3538 }
3539
3540
3541 \f
3542 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3543
3544 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3545
3546 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3547 the mouse. */
3548
3549 static Lisp_Object
3550 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3551 struct input_event *result;
3552 XButtonEvent *event;
3553 struct frame *f;
3554 {
3555 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3556 otherwise. */
3557 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3558 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3559 result->timestamp = event->time;
3560 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3561 event->state)
3562 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3563 ? up_modifier
3564 : down_modifier));
3565
3566 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3567 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3568 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3569 result->arg = Qnil;
3570 return Qnil;
3571 }
3572
3573 \f
3574 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3575 The input handler calls this.
3576
3577 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3578 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3579 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3580 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3581
3582 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3583 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3584
3585 static int
3586 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3587 FRAME_PTR frame;
3588 XMotionEvent *event;
3589 {
3590 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3591 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3592 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3593
3594 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3595 return 0;
3596
3597 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3598 {
3599 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3600 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3601 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3602 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3603 return 1;
3604 }
3605
3606
3607 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3608 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3609 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3610 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3611 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3612 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3613 {
3614 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3615 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3616 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3617 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3618 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3619 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3620 return 1;
3621 }
3622
3623 return 0;
3624 }
3625
3626 \f
3627 /************************************************************************
3628 Mouse Face
3629 ************************************************************************/
3630
3631 static void
3632 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3633 {
3634 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3635 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3636 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3637 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3638 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3639 }
3640
3641
3642
3643 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3644 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3645
3646 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3647 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3648 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3649 position on the scroll bar.
3650
3651 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3652 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3653 the mouse is over.
3654
3655 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3656 was at this position.
3657
3658 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3659
3660 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3661 movement. */
3662
3663 static void
3664 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
3665 FRAME_PTR *fp;
3666 int insist;
3667 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
3668 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
3669 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
3670 unsigned long *time;
3671 {
3672 FRAME_PTR f1;
3673
3674 BLOCK_INPUT;
3675
3676 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3677 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3678 else
3679 {
3680 Window root;
3681 int root_x, root_y;
3682
3683 Window dummy_window;
3684 int dummy;
3685
3686 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3687
3688 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3689 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3690 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3691 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3692
3693 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3694
3695 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3696 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3697 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3698
3699 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3700 &root,
3701
3702 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3703 a different screen. */
3704 &dummy_window,
3705
3706 /* The position on that root window. */
3707 &root_x, &root_y,
3708
3709 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3710 &dummy, &dummy,
3711
3712 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3713 we don't care. */
3714 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3715
3716 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3717 containing the pointer. */
3718 {
3719 Window win, child;
3720 int win_x, win_y;
3721 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3722
3723 win = root;
3724
3725 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3726 structure is changing at the same time this function
3727 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3728
3729 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3730
3731 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3732 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3733 {
3734 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3735 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3736 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3737
3738 /* From-window, to-window. */
3739 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3740
3741 /* From-position, to-position. */
3742 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3743
3744 /* Child of win. */
3745 &child);
3746 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3747 }
3748 else
3749 {
3750 while (1)
3751 {
3752 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3753
3754 /* From-window, to-window. */
3755 root, win,
3756
3757 /* From-position, to-position. */
3758 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3759
3760 /* Child of win. */
3761 &child);
3762
3763 if (child == None || child == win)
3764 break;
3765
3766 win = child;
3767 parent_x = win_x;
3768 parent_y = win_y;
3769 }
3770
3771 /* Now we know that:
3772 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3773 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3774 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3775 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3776 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3777 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3778 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3779 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3780 never use them in that case.) */
3781
3782 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3783 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3784
3785 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3786 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3787 on the frame. */
3788 if (f1 != NULL
3789 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3790 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3791 f1 = NULL;
3792 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3793 }
3794
3795 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3796 f1 = 0;
3797
3798 x_uncatch_errors ();
3799
3800 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3801 if (! f1)
3802 {
3803 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3804
3805 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3806
3807 if (bar)
3808 {
3809 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3810 win_x = parent_x;
3811 win_y = parent_y;
3812 }
3813 }
3814
3815 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3816 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3817
3818 if (f1)
3819 {
3820 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3821 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3822 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3823 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3824 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3825 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3826 the frame are divided into. */
3827
3828 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3829 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
3830
3831 *bar_window = Qnil;
3832 *part = 0;
3833 *fp = f1;
3834 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3835 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3836 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3837 }
3838 }
3839 }
3840
3841 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3842 }
3843
3844
3845 \f
3846 /***********************************************************************
3847 Scroll bars
3848 ***********************************************************************/
3849
3850 /* Scroll bar support. */
3851
3852 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
3853 manages it.
3854 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3855 bits. */
3856
3857 static struct scroll_bar *
3858 x_window_to_scroll_bar (display, window_id)
3859 Display *display;
3860 Window window_id;
3861 {
3862 Lisp_Object tail;
3863
3864 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3865 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
3866 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
3867
3868 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3869 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3870 tail = XCDR (tail))
3871 {
3872 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3873
3874 frame = XCAR (tail);
3875 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3876 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
3877 abort ();
3878
3879 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3880 right window ID. */
3881 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3882 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3883 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3884 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3885 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3886 condemned = Qnil,
3887 ! GC_NILP (bar));
3888 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3889 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id &&
3890 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
3891 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3892 }
3893
3894 return 0;
3895 }
3896
3897
3898 #if defined USE_LUCID
3899
3900 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3901 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3902
3903 static Widget
3904 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
3905 Window window;
3906 {
3907 Lisp_Object tail;
3908
3909 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3910 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3911 tail = XCDR (tail))
3912 {
3913 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3914 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3915
3916 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3917 return menu_bar;
3918 }
3919
3920 return NULL;
3921 }
3922
3923 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
3924
3925 \f
3926 /************************************************************************
3927 Toolkit scroll bars
3928 ************************************************************************/
3929
3930 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3931
3932 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
3933 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
3934 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
3935 struct scroll_bar *));
3936 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
3937 int, int, int));
3938
3939
3940 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
3941 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
3942
3943 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
3944
3945 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
3946
3947 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
3948
3949 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
3950 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
3951
3952 #ifndef USE_GTK
3953 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
3954
3955 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
3956
3957 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
3958
3959 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
3960 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
3961 to avoid jerkyness. */
3962
3963 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
3964
3965 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
3966 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
3967 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
3968 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
3969
3970 static void
3971 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
3972 num_params)
3973 Widget widget;
3974 XtPointer client_data;
3975 String action_name;
3976 XEvent *event;
3977 String *params;
3978 Cardinal *num_params;
3979 {
3980 int scroll_bar_p;
3981 char *end_action;
3982
3983 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
3984 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
3985 end_action = "Release";
3986 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
3987 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
3988 end_action = "EndScroll";
3989 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
3990
3991 if (scroll_bar_p
3992 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
3993 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
3994 {
3995 struct window *w;
3996
3997 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
3998 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
3999 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4000
4001 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4002 {
4003 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4004 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4005 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4006 }
4007 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4008 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4009
4010 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4011 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4012 }
4013 }
4014 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4015
4016 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4017 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4018
4019 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4020 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4021
4022
4023 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4024 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4025 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4026 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4027
4028 static void
4029 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4030 Lisp_Object window;
4031 int part, portion, whole;
4032 {
4033 XEvent event;
4034 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4035 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4036 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4037 int i;
4038
4039 BLOCK_INPUT;
4040
4041 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4042 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4043 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4044 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4045 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4046 ev->format = 32;
4047
4048 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4049 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4050 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4051 into that array in the event. */
4052 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4053 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4054 break;
4055
4056 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4057 {
4058 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4059 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4060 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4061
4062 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4063 nbytes);
4064 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4065 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4066 }
4067
4068 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4069 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4070 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4071 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4072 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4073 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4074
4075 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4076 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4077
4078 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4079 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4080 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4081 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4082 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4083 }
4084
4085
4086 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4087 in *IEVENT. */
4088
4089 static void
4090 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4091 XEvent *event;
4092 struct input_event *ievent;
4093 {
4094 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4095 Lisp_Object window;
4096 struct frame *f;
4097 struct window *w;
4098
4099 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4100 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4101
4102 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4103 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4104
4105 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4106 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4107 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4108 #ifdef USE_GTK
4109 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4110 #else
4111 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4112 #endif
4113 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4114 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4115 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4116 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4117 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4118 }
4119
4120
4121 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4122
4123 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4124
4125 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4126
4127
4128 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4129 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4130 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4131
4132 static void
4133 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4134 Widget widget;
4135 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4136 {
4137 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4138 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4139 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4140
4141 switch (cs->reason)
4142 {
4143 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4144 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4145 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4146 break;
4147
4148 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4149 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4150 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4151 break;
4152
4153 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4154 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4155 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4156 break;
4157
4158 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4159 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4160 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4161 break;
4162
4163 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4164 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4165 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4166 break;
4167
4168 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4169 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4170 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4171 break;
4172
4173 case XmCR_DRAG:
4174 {
4175 int slider_size;
4176
4177 /* Get the slider size. */
4178 BLOCK_INPUT;
4179 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4180 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4181
4182 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4183 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4184 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4185 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4186 }
4187 break;
4188
4189 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4190 break;
4191 };
4192
4193 if (part >= 0)
4194 {
4195 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4196 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4197 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4198 }
4199 }
4200
4201
4202 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw or GTK */
4203 #ifdef USE_GTK
4204 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4205 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4206
4207 static void
4208 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4209 GtkRange *widget;
4210 gpointer data;
4211 {
4212 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4213 gdouble previous;
4214 gdouble position;
4215 gdouble *p;
4216 int diff;
4217
4218 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4219 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4220
4221 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4222
4223 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4224 if (! p)
4225 {
4226 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4227 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4228 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4229 }
4230
4231 previous = *p;
4232 *p = position;
4233
4234 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4235
4236 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4237
4238 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4239 {
4240 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4241 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4242 }
4243 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4244 {
4245 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4246 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4247 }
4248 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4249 {
4250 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4251 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4252 }
4253 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4254 {
4255 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4256 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4257 }
4258 else
4259 {
4260 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4261 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4262 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4263 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4264 }
4265
4266 if (part >= 0)
4267 {
4268 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4269 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4270 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4271 }
4272 }
4273
4274 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4275
4276 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4277 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4278 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4279 the thumb is. */
4280
4281 static void
4282 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4283 Widget widget;
4284 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4285 {
4286 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4287 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4288 float shown;
4289 int whole, portion, height;
4290 int part;
4291
4292 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4293 BLOCK_INPUT;
4294 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4295 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4296
4297 whole = 10000000;
4298 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4299
4300 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4301 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4302 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4303 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4304 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4305 bottom). */
4306 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4307 else
4308 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4309
4310 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4311 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4312 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4313 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4314 }
4315
4316
4317 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4318 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4319 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4320 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4321 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4322 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4323 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4324
4325 static void
4326 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4327 Widget widget;
4328 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4329 {
4330 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4331 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4332 int position = (long) call_data;
4333 Dimension height;
4334 int part;
4335
4336 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4337 BLOCK_INPUT;
4338 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4339 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4340
4341 if (abs (position) >= height)
4342 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4343
4344 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4345 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4346 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4347 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4348 else
4349 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4350
4351 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4352 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4353 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4354 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4355 }
4356
4357 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4358 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
4359
4360 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4361
4362 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4363 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4364
4365 #ifdef USE_GTK
4366 static void
4367 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4368 struct frame *f;
4369 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4370 {
4371 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4372
4373 BLOCK_INPUT;
4374 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4375 scroll_bar_name);
4376 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4377 }
4378
4379 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4380
4381 static void
4382 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4383 struct frame *f;
4384 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4385 {
4386 Window xwindow;
4387 Widget widget;
4388 Arg av[20];
4389 int ac = 0;
4390 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4391 unsigned long pixel;
4392
4393 BLOCK_INPUT;
4394
4395 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4396 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4397 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4398 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4399 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4400 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4401 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4402 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4403 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4404
4405 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4406 if (pixel != -1)
4407 {
4408 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4409 ++ac;
4410 }
4411
4412 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4413 if (pixel != -1)
4414 {
4415 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4416 ++ac;
4417 }
4418
4419 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4420 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4421
4422 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4423 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4424 (XtPointer) bar);
4425 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4426 (XtPointer) bar);
4427 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4428 (XtPointer) bar);
4429 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4430 (XtPointer) bar);
4431 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4432 (XtPointer) bar);
4433 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4434 (XtPointer) bar);
4435 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4436 (XtPointer) bar);
4437
4438 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4439 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4440
4441 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4442 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4443 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4444 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4445
4446 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4447
4448 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4449 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4450 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4451 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4452 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4453 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4454 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4455 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4456
4457 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4458 if (pixel != -1)
4459 {
4460 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4461 ++ac;
4462 }
4463
4464 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4465 if (pixel != -1)
4466 {
4467 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4468 ++ac;
4469 }
4470
4471 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4472
4473 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4474 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4475 {
4476 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4477 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4478 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4479 pixel = -1;
4480 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4481 }
4482 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4483 {
4484 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4485 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4486 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4487 pixel = -1;
4488 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4489 }
4490
4491 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4492 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4493 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4494 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4495 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4496 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4497 {
4498 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4499 ++ac;
4500 }
4501 else
4502 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4503 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4504 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4505 {
4506 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4507 the shadows. */
4508 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4509 ++ac;
4510
4511 /* Specify the colors. */
4512 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4513 if (pixel != -1)
4514 {
4515 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4516 ++ac;
4517 }
4518 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4519 if (pixel != -1)
4520 {
4521 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4522 ++ac;
4523 }
4524 }
4525 #endif
4526
4527 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4528 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4529
4530 {
4531 char *initial = "";
4532 char *val = initial;
4533 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4534 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4535 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4536 #endif
4537 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4538 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4539 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4540 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4541 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4542 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4543 }
4544 }
4545
4546 /* Define callbacks. */
4547 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4548 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4549 (XtPointer) bar);
4550
4551 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4552 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4553
4554 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4555
4556 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4557 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4558 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4559 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4560
4561 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4562 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4563 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4564 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
4565
4566 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4567 }
4568 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4569
4570
4571 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4572 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4573
4574 #ifdef USE_GTK
4575 static void
4576 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4577 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4578 int portion, position, whole;
4579 {
4580 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4581 }
4582
4583 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4584 static void
4585 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4586 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4587 int portion, position, whole;
4588 {
4589 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4590 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4591 float top, shown;
4592
4593 BLOCK_INPUT;
4594
4595 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4596
4597 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4598 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4599 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4600 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4601 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4602 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4603 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4604 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4605 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4606 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4607 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4608 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4609 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4610 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4611 whole += portion;
4612
4613 if (whole <= 0)
4614 top = 0, shown = 1;
4615 else
4616 {
4617 top = (float) position / whole;
4618 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4619 }
4620
4621 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4622 {
4623 int size, value;
4624
4625 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4626 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4627 value. */
4628 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4629 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4630 size = max (size, 1);
4631
4632 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4633 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4634 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4635
4636 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4637 }
4638 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4639
4640 if (whole == 0)
4641 top = 0, shown = 1;
4642 else
4643 {
4644 top = (float) position / whole;
4645 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4646 }
4647
4648 {
4649 float old_top, old_shown;
4650 Dimension height;
4651 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4652 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4653 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4654 XtNheight, &height,
4655 NULL);
4656
4657 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4658 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4659 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4660 else
4661 top = old_top;
4662 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4663 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4664
4665 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4666 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4667 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4668 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4669 {
4670 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4671 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4672 else
4673 {
4674 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4675 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4676 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4677
4678 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4679 }
4680 }
4681 }
4682 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4683
4684 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4685 }
4686 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4687
4688 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4689
4690
4691 \f
4692 /************************************************************************
4693 Scroll bars, general
4694 ************************************************************************/
4695
4696 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4697 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4698 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4699 scroll bar. */
4700
4701 static struct scroll_bar *
4702 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
4703 struct window *w;
4704 int top, left, width, height;
4705 {
4706 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4707 struct scroll_bar *bar
4708 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
4709
4710 BLOCK_INPUT;
4711
4712 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4713 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4714 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4715 {
4716 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4717 unsigned long mask;
4718 Window window;
4719
4720 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4721 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4722 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
4723
4724 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4725 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4726 | ExposureMask);
4727 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4728
4729 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4730
4731 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4732 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4733 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4734 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4735 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4736 left, top, width,
4737 window_box_height (w), False);
4738
4739 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4740 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4741 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4742 top,
4743 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4744 height,
4745 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4746 0,
4747 CopyFromParent,
4748 CopyFromParent,
4749 CopyFromParent,
4750 /* Attributes. */
4751 mask, &a);
4752 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
4753 }
4754 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4755
4756 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4757 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
4758 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
4759 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
4760 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
4761 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
4762 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
4763 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4764
4765 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4766 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4767 bar->prev = Qnil;
4768 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4769 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4770 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4771
4772 /* Map the window/widget. */
4773 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4774 {
4775 #ifdef USE_GTK
4776 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4777 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
4778 top,
4779 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4780 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4781 max (height, 1));
4782 xg_show_scroll_bar (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4783 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4784 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4785 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4786 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4787 top,
4788 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4789 max (height, 1), 0);
4790 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4791 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4792 }
4793 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4794 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4795 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4796
4797 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4798 return bar;
4799 }
4800
4801
4802 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4803
4804 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4805 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4806 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4807 events.)
4808
4809 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4810 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4811 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4812 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4813 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4814
4815 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4816
4817 static void
4818 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
4819 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4820 int start, end;
4821 int rebuild;
4822 {
4823 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4824 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
4825 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4826 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4827
4828 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4829 if (! rebuild
4830 && start == XINT (bar->start)
4831 && end == XINT (bar->end))
4832 return;
4833
4834 BLOCK_INPUT;
4835
4836 {
4837 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
4838 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
4839 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
4840
4841 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4842 the distance between start and end. */
4843 {
4844 int length = end - start;
4845
4846 if (start < 0)
4847 start = 0;
4848 else if (start > top_range)
4849 start = top_range;
4850 end = start + length;
4851
4852 if (end < start)
4853 end = start;
4854 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4855 end = top_range;
4856 }
4857
4858 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4859 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
4860 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
4861
4862 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4863 if (end > top_range)
4864 end = top_range;
4865
4866 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4867 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4868 that many pixels tall. */
4869 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4870
4871 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4872 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4873 if (0 < start)
4874 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4875 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4876 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4877 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4878 inside_width, start,
4879 False);
4880
4881 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4882 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4883 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4884 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4885
4886 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4887 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4888 /* x, y, width, height */
4889 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4890 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4891 inside_width, end - start);
4892
4893 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4894 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4895 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4896 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
4897
4898 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4899 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4900 if (end < inside_height)
4901 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4902 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4903 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4904 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4905 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4906 False);
4907
4908 }
4909
4910 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4911 }
4912
4913 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4914
4915 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4916 nil. */
4917
4918 static void
4919 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
4920 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4921 {
4922 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4923 BLOCK_INPUT;
4924
4925 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4926 #ifdef USE_GTK
4927 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4928 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4929 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
4930 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4931 #else
4932 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4933 #endif
4934
4935 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
4936 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
4937
4938 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4939 }
4940
4941
4942 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
4943 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
4944 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
4945 create one. */
4946
4947 static void
4948 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
4949 struct window *w;
4950 int portion, whole, position;
4951 {
4952 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4953 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4954 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
4955 int window_y, window_height;
4956
4957 /* Get window dimensions. */
4958 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
4959 top = window_y;
4960 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
4961 height = window_height;
4962
4963 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
4964 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
4965
4966 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
4967 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
4968 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
4969 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
4970 else
4971 sb_width = width;
4972
4973 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
4974 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4975 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
4976 sb_left = (left +
4977 (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
4978 ? width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2
4979 : 0));
4980 else
4981 sb_left = (left +
4982 (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
4983 ? (width - sb_width) / 2
4984 : width - sb_width));
4985 #else
4986 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
4987 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
4988 else
4989 sb_left = left;
4990 #endif
4991
4992 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
4993 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
4994 {
4995 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4996 {
4997 BLOCK_INPUT;
4998 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4999 left, top, width, height, False);
5000 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5001 }
5002
5003 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5004 }
5005 else
5006 {
5007 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5008 unsigned int mask = 0;
5009
5010 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5011
5012 BLOCK_INPUT;
5013
5014 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
5015 mask |= CWX;
5016 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
5017 mask |= CWY;
5018 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
5019 mask |= CWWidth;
5020 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
5021 mask |= CWHeight;
5022
5023 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5024
5025 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5026 if (mask)
5027 {
5028 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5029 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5030 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5031 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5032 left, top, width, height, False);
5033 #ifdef USE_GTK
5034 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5035 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5036 top,
5037 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5038 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5039 max (height, 1));
5040 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5041 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5042 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5043 top,
5044 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5045 max (height, 1), 0);
5046 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5047 }
5048 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5049
5050 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5051 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5052 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5053 {
5054 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5055 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5056 height, False);
5057 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5058 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5059 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5060 height, False);
5061 }
5062
5063 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5064 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5065 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5066 example. */
5067 {
5068 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5069 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5070 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5071 {
5072 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5073 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5074 left + area_width - rest, top,
5075 rest, height, False);
5076 else
5077 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5078 left, top, rest, height, False);
5079 }
5080 }
5081
5082 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5083 if (mask)
5084 {
5085 XWindowChanges wc;
5086
5087 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5088 wc.y = top;
5089 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5090 wc.height = height;
5091 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5092 mask, &wc);
5093 }
5094
5095 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5096
5097 /* Remember new settings. */
5098 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
5099 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
5100 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
5101 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
5102
5103 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5104 }
5105
5106 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5107 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5108 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5109 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5110 dragged. */
5111 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5112 {
5113 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5114
5115 if (whole == 0)
5116 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5117 else
5118 {
5119 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5120 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5121 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5122 }
5123 }
5124 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5125
5126 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5127 }
5128
5129
5130 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5131 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5132 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5133 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5134 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5135 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5136 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5137
5138 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5139 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5140 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5141
5142 static void
5143 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5144 FRAME_PTR frame;
5145 {
5146 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5147 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5148 {
5149 Lisp_Object bar;
5150 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5151 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5152 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5153 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5154 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5155 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5156 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5157 }
5158 }
5159
5160
5161 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5162 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5163
5164 static void
5165 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5166 struct window *window;
5167 {
5168 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5169 struct frame *f;
5170
5171 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5172 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5173 abort ();
5174
5175 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5176
5177 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5178 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5179 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5180 {
5181 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5182 the lists. */
5183 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5184 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5185 return;
5186 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5187 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5188 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5189 else
5190 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5191 one or the other! */
5192 abort ();
5193 }
5194 else
5195 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5196
5197 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5198 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5199
5200 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5201 bar->prev = Qnil;
5202 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5203 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5204 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5205 }
5206
5207 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5208 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5209
5210 static void
5211 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5212 FRAME_PTR f;
5213 {
5214 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5215
5216 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5217
5218 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5219 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5220 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5221
5222 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5223 {
5224 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5225
5226 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5227
5228 next = b->next;
5229 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5230 }
5231
5232 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5233 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5234 }
5235
5236
5237 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5238 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5239 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5240
5241 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5242 mark bits. */
5243
5244 static void
5245 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5246 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5247 XEvent *event;
5248 {
5249 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5250 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5251 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5252 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5253
5254 BLOCK_INPUT;
5255
5256 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
5257
5258 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5259 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5260
5261 /* x, y, width, height */
5262 0, 0,
5263 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5264 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
5265
5266 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5267
5268 }
5269 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5270
5271 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5272 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5273
5274 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5275 mark bits. */
5276
5277
5278 static void
5279 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5280 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5281 XEvent *event;
5282 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5283 {
5284 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
5285 abort ();
5286
5287 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5288 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5289 emacs_event->modifiers
5290 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5291 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5292 event->xbutton.state)
5293 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5294 ? up_modifier
5295 : down_modifier));
5296 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5297 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5298 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5299 {
5300 #if 0
5301 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5302 int internal_height
5303 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5304 #endif
5305 int top_range
5306 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5307 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5308
5309 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5310 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5311
5312 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
5313 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5314 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5315 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5316 else
5317 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5318
5319 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5320 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5321 whether or not we're dragging. */
5322 #if 0
5323 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5324 holding it. */
5325 if (event->type == ButtonPress
5326 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5327 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
5328 #endif
5329
5330 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5331 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5332 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5333 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5334 {
5335 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5336 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5337
5338 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5339 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5340 }
5341 #endif
5342
5343 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5344 #if 0
5345 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5346 the handle. */
5347 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5348 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
5349 else
5350 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5351 #else
5352 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5353 #endif
5354
5355 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5356 }
5357 }
5358
5359 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5360
5361 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5362
5363 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5364 mark bits. */
5365
5366 static void
5367 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5368 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5369 XEvent *event;
5370 {
5371 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5372
5373 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5374
5375 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5376 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5377
5378 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5379 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
5380 {
5381 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5382 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5383
5384 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
5385 {
5386 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5387
5388 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5389 }
5390 }
5391 }
5392
5393 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5394
5395 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5396 on the scroll bar. */
5397
5398 static void
5399 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5400 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5401 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5402 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5403 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5404 unsigned long *time;
5405 {
5406 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5407 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5408 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5409 int win_x, win_y;
5410 Window dummy_window;
5411 int dummy_coord;
5412 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5413
5414 BLOCK_INPUT;
5415
5416 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5417 report that. */
5418 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5419
5420 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5421 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5422 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5423
5424 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5425 &win_x, &win_y,
5426
5427 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5428 &dummy_mask))
5429 ;
5430 else
5431 {
5432 #if 0
5433 int inside_height
5434 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5435 #endif
5436 int top_range
5437 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5438
5439 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5440
5441 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5442 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5443
5444 if (win_y < 0)
5445 win_y = 0;
5446 if (win_y > top_range)
5447 win_y = top_range;
5448
5449 *fp = f;
5450 *bar_window = bar->window;
5451
5452 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5453 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5454 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
5455 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5456 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5457 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5458 else
5459 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5460
5461 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5462 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5463
5464 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5465 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5466 }
5467
5468 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5469
5470 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5471 }
5472
5473
5474 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5475 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5476 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5477 redraw them. */
5478
5479 void
5480 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5481 FRAME_PTR f;
5482 {
5483 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5484 Lisp_Object bar;
5485
5486 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5487 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5488 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5489 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5490 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5491 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5492 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5493 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
5494 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5495 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5496 }
5497
5498 \f
5499 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5500
5501 #if 0
5502 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5503 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5504 sometimes don't work. */
5505
5506 static Time enter_timestamp;
5507 #endif
5508
5509 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5510 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5511 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5512 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5513
5514 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5515 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5516
5517 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5518
5519 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5520 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5521
5522 static int temp_index;
5523 static short temp_buffer[100];
5524
5525 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5526 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5527 temp_index = 0; \
5528 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5529
5530 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5531 on a particular display. */
5532
5533 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5534
5535 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5536 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5537 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5538 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5539
5540 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5541
5542 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5543 do \
5544 { \
5545 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5546 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5547 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5548 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5549 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5550 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5551 } \
5552 while (0)
5553
5554 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5555 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5556
5557
5558 enum
5559 {
5560 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5561 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5562 X_EVENT_DROP
5563 };
5564
5565 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5566 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5567 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5568
5569 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5570 this event further.
5571 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5572
5573 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5574 static int
5575 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5576 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5577 XEvent *event;
5578 {
5579 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5580 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5581 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5582 was created. */
5583
5584 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5585 event->xclient.window);
5586
5587 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5588 }
5589 #endif
5590
5591 #ifdef USE_GTK
5592 static int current_count;
5593 static int current_finish;
5594 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5595
5596 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5597 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5598 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5599 static GdkFilterReturn
5600 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5601 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5602 GdkEvent *ev;
5603 gpointer data;
5604 {
5605 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5606
5607 if (current_count >= 0)
5608 {
5609 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5610
5611 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5612
5613 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5614 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5615 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5616 so we do it here. */
5617 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5618 if (dpyinfo && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5619 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5620 #endif
5621
5622 if (! dpyinfo)
5623 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5624 else
5625 {
5626 current_count +=
5627 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5628 current_hold_quit);
5629 }
5630 }
5631 else
5632 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5633
5634 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5635 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5636
5637 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5638 }
5639 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5640
5641
5642 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5643
5644 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5645 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5646 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5647
5648 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5649
5650 static int
5651 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, finish, hold_quit)
5652 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5653 XEvent *eventp;
5654 int *finish;
5655 struct input_event *hold_quit;
5656 {
5657 union {
5658 struct input_event ie;
5659 struct selection_input_event sie;
5660 } inev;
5661 int count = 0;
5662 int do_help = 0;
5663 int nbytes = 0;
5664 struct frame *f;
5665 struct coding_system coding;
5666 XEvent event = *eventp;
5667
5668 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5669
5670 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5671 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5672 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5673
5674 switch (event.type)
5675 {
5676 case ClientMessage:
5677 {
5678 if (event.xclient.message_type
5679 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5680 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5681 {
5682 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5683 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5684 {
5685 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5686 could be the shell widget window
5687 if the frame has no title bar. */
5688 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5689 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5690 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5691 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5692 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5693 #endif
5694 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5695 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5696 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5697 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5698 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5699 needed.
5700
5701 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5702 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5703 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5704 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5705 Emacs. */
5706
5707 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5708 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5709 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5710 if (f)
5711 {
5712 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5713 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5714 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5715 x_catch_errors (d);
5716 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5717 /* The ICCCM says this is
5718 the only valid choice. */
5719 RevertToParent,
5720 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5721 /* This is needed to detect the error
5722 if there is an error. */
5723 XSync (d, False);
5724 x_uncatch_errors ();
5725 }
5726 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5727 #endif /* 0 */
5728 goto done;
5729 }
5730
5731 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5732 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5733 {
5734 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5735 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5736 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5737 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5738 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5739 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5740 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5741 session manager and one for this. */
5742 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5743 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5744 #endif
5745 {
5746 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5747 event.xclient.window);
5748 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5749 for a single Emacs process. */
5750 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5751 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5752 event.xclient.window,
5753 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5754 else if (f)
5755 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5756 event.xclient.window,
5757 0, 0);
5758 }
5759 goto done;
5760 }
5761
5762 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5763 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5764 {
5765 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5766 event.xclient.window);
5767 if (!f)
5768 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5769
5770 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5771 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5772 goto done;
5773 }
5774
5775 goto done;
5776 }
5777
5778 if (event.xclient.message_type
5779 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5780 {
5781 goto done;
5782 }
5783
5784 if (event.xclient.message_type
5785 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5786 {
5787 int new_x, new_y;
5788 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5789
5790 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5791 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5792
5793 if (f)
5794 {
5795 f->left_pos = new_x;
5796 f->top_pos = new_y;
5797 }
5798 goto done;
5799 }
5800
5801 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5802 if (event.xclient.message_type
5803 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5804 {
5805 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5806 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5807 &event, NULL);
5808 goto done;
5809 }
5810 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5811
5812 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5813 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5814 || (event.xclient.message_type
5815 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5816 {
5817 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5818 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5819 currently never do because we are interested in
5820 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5821 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5822 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5823 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5824 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5825 goto done;
5826 }
5827
5828 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5829 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5830 we construct an input_event. */
5831 if (event.xclient.message_type
5832 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5833 {
5834 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
5835 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5836 goto done;
5837 }
5838 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5839
5840 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5841
5842 if (!f)
5843 goto OTHER;
5844
5845 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
5846 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5847 }
5848 break;
5849
5850 case SelectionNotify:
5851 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5852 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5853 goto OTHER;
5854 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5855 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5856 break;
5857
5858 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5859 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5860 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5861 goto OTHER;
5862 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5863 {
5864 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
5865
5866 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
5867 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5868 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5869 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5870 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5871 }
5872 break;
5873
5874 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5875 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5876 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
5877 goto OTHER;
5878 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5879 {
5880 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
5881 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
5882
5883 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
5884 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5885 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
5886 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5887 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
5888 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
5889 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5890 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5891 }
5892 break;
5893
5894 case PropertyNotify:
5895 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
5896 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
5897 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
5898 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
5899 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
5900 goto OTHER;
5901 #endif
5902 #endif
5903 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
5904 goto OTHER;
5905
5906 case ReparentNotify:
5907 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
5908 if (f)
5909 {
5910 int x, y;
5911 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
5912 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
5913 f->left_pos = x;
5914 f->top_pos = y;
5915
5916 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
5917 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
5918 }
5919 goto OTHER;
5920
5921 case Expose:
5922 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
5923 if (f)
5924 {
5925 x_check_fullscreen (f);
5926
5927 #ifdef USE_GTK
5928 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
5929 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
5930 event.xexpose.window,
5931 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5932 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
5933 FALSE);
5934 #endif
5935 if (f->async_visible == 0)
5936 {
5937 f->async_visible = 1;
5938 f->async_iconified = 0;
5939 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
5940 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
5941 }
5942 else
5943 expose_frame (f,
5944 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5945 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
5946 }
5947 else
5948 {
5949 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5950 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5951 #endif
5952 #if defined USE_LUCID
5953 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
5954 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
5955 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
5956 {
5957 Widget widget
5958 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
5959 if (widget)
5960 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
5961 }
5962 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
5963
5964 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5965 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
5966 goto OTHER;
5967 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5968 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
5969 event.xexpose.window);
5970
5971 if (bar)
5972 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
5973 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5974 else
5975 goto OTHER;
5976 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5977 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5978 }
5979 break;
5980
5981 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
5982 source area was obscured or not
5983 available. */
5984 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
5985 if (f)
5986 {
5987 expose_frame (f,
5988 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
5989 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
5990 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
5991 }
5992 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5993 else
5994 goto OTHER;
5995 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5996 break;
5997
5998 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
5999 source area was completely
6000 available. */
6001 break;
6002
6003 case UnmapNotify:
6004 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6005 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6006 {
6007 tip_window = 0;
6008 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6009 }
6010
6011 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6012 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6013 the frame was deleted. */
6014 {
6015 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6016 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6017 display that won't ever be seen. */
6018 f->async_visible = 0;
6019 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6020 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6021 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6022 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6023 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6024 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6025 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6026 {
6027 f->async_iconified = 1;
6028
6029 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6030 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6031 }
6032 }
6033 goto OTHER;
6034
6035 case MapNotify:
6036 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6037 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6038 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6039 goto OTHER;
6040
6041 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6042 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6043 frame is visible. */
6044 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6045 if (f)
6046 {
6047 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6048 the frame's display structures.
6049 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6050 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6051 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6052 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6053 if (! f->async_iconified)
6054 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6055
6056 f->async_visible = 1;
6057 f->async_iconified = 0;
6058 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6059
6060 if (f->iconified)
6061 {
6062 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6063 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6064 }
6065 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6066 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6067 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6068 to update the frame titles
6069 in case this is the second frame. */
6070 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6071 }
6072 goto OTHER;
6073
6074 case KeyPress:
6075
6076 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6077
6078 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6079 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6080 if (popup_activated ())
6081 goto OTHER;
6082 #endif
6083
6084 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6085
6086 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight))
6087 {
6088 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6089 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6090 }
6091
6092 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6093 if (f == 0)
6094 {
6095 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6096 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6097 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6098 event.xkey.window);
6099 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6100 {
6101 widget = XtParent (widget);
6102 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6103 }
6104 }
6105 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6106
6107 if (f != 0)
6108 {
6109 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6110 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6111 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6112 his Emacs hang.
6113
6114 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6115 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6116 status_return even if the input is too long to
6117 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6118 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6119 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6120 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6121 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6122 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6123 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6124 int modifiers;
6125 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6126 Lisp_Object c;
6127
6128 #ifdef USE_GTK
6129 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6130 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6131 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6132 (see above). */
6133 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6134 #endif
6135
6136 event.xkey.state
6137 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6138 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6139 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6140
6141 /* This will have to go some day... */
6142
6143 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6144 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6145 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6146 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6147 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6148 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6149 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6150
6151 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6152 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6153 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6154 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6155 not it is combined with Meta. */
6156 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6157 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6158
6159 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6160 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6161 {
6162 Status status_return;
6163
6164 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6165 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6166 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6167 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6168 &status_return);
6169 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6170 {
6171 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6172 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6173 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6174 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6175 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6176 &status_return);
6177 }
6178 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6179 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6180 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
6181 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6182 coding_system = Qutf_8;
6183 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6184 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6185 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6186 &status_return);
6187 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6188 {
6189 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6190 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6191 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6192 &event.xkey,
6193 copy_bufptr,
6194 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6195 &status_return);
6196 }
6197 }
6198 #endif
6199
6200 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6201 break;
6202 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6203 {
6204 keysym = NoSymbol;
6205 modifiers = 0;
6206 }
6207 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6208 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6209 abort ();
6210 }
6211 else
6212 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6213 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6214 &compose_status);
6215 #else
6216 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6217 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6218 &compose_status);
6219 #endif
6220
6221 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6222 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6223 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6224 break;
6225
6226 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6227 orig_keysym = keysym;
6228
6229 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6230 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6231 inev.ie.modifiers
6232 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6233 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6234
6235 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6236 translations to characters. */
6237 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6238 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6239 {
6240 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6241 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6242 goto done_keysym;
6243 }
6244
6245 /* Keysyms directly mapped to supported Unicode characters. */
6246 if ((keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x010033ff)
6247 || (keysym >= 0x0100e000 && keysym <= 0x0100ffff))
6248 {
6249 int code = keysym & 0xFFFF, charset_id, c1, c2;
6250
6251 if (code < 0x80)
6252 {
6253 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6254 inev.ie.code = code;
6255 }
6256 else if (code < 0x100)
6257 {
6258 if (code < 0xA0)
6259 charset_id = CHARSET_8_BIT_CONTROL;
6260 else
6261 charset_id = charset_latin_iso8859_1;
6262 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6263 inev.ie.code = MAKE_CHAR (charset_id, code, 0);
6264 }
6265 else
6266 {
6267 if (code < 0x2500)
6268 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_0100_24ff,
6269 code -= 0x100;
6270 else if (code < 0xE000)
6271 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_2500_33ff,
6272 code -= 0x2500;
6273 else
6274 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_e000_ffff,
6275 code -= 0xE000;
6276 c1 = (code / 96) + 32, c2 = (code % 96) + 32;
6277 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6278 inev.ie.code = MAKE_CHAR (charset_id, c1, c2);
6279 }
6280 goto done_keysym;
6281 }
6282
6283 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6284 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6285 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6286 Vx_keysym_table,
6287 Qnil))))
6288 {
6289 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6290 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6291 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6292 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6293 goto done_keysym;
6294 }
6295
6296 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6297 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6298 || keysym == XK_Delete
6299 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6300 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6301 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6302 #endif
6303 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6304 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6305 #ifdef HPUX
6306 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6307 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6308 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6309 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6310 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6311 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6312 #endif
6313 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6314 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6315 #endif
6316 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6317 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6318 #endif
6319 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6320 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6321 #endif
6322 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6323 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6324 #endif
6325 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6326 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6327 #endif
6328 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6329 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6330 #endif
6331 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6332 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6333 #endif
6334 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6335 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6336 #endif
6337 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6338 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6339 #endif
6340 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6341 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6342 #endif
6343 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6344 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6345 #endif
6346 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6347 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6348 #endif
6349 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6350 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6351 #endif
6352 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6353 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6354 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6355 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6356 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6357 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6358 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
6359 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
6360 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
6361 #endif
6362 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
6363 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
6364 #endif
6365 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
6366 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6367 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6368 don't have real modifiers but
6369 should be treated similarly to
6370 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6371 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6372 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6373 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6374 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6375 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6376 #endif
6377 ))
6378 {
6379 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6380 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6381 key. */
6382 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6383 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6384 goto done_keysym;
6385 }
6386
6387 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6388 register int i;
6389 register int c;
6390 int nchars, len;
6391
6392 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6393 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6394 we used just above and the locale. */
6395 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6396 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6397 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6398 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6399 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6400 gives us composition information. */
6401 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6402
6403 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6404 {
6405 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6406 }
6407
6408 {
6409 /* Decode the input data. */
6410 int require;
6411 unsigned char *p;
6412
6413 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
6414 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
6415 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6416 /* We explicitly disable composition handling because
6417 key data should not contain any composition sequence. */
6418 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6419 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p, nbytes, require);
6420 nbytes = coding.produced;
6421 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6422 copy_bufptr = p;
6423 }
6424
6425 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6426 character events. */
6427 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6428 {
6429 if (nchars == nbytes)
6430 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6431 else
6432 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6433 nbytes - i, len);
6434 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6435 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6436 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6437 inev.ie.code = c;
6438 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6439 }
6440
6441 /* Previous code updated count by nchars rather than nbytes,
6442 but that seems bogus to me. ++kfs */
6443 count += nbytes;
6444
6445 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6446
6447 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6448 break;
6449 }
6450 }
6451 done_keysym:
6452 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6453 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6454 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6455 client. */
6456 break;
6457 #else
6458 goto OTHER;
6459 #endif
6460
6461 case KeyRelease:
6462 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6463 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6464 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6465 client. */
6466 break;
6467 #else
6468 goto OTHER;
6469 #endif
6470
6471 case EnterNotify:
6472 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6473
6474 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6475
6476 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6477 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6478
6479 #if 0
6480 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
6481 {
6482 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6483 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
6484 || !(f->auto_lower)
6485 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
6486 {
6487 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
6488 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
6489 }
6490 }
6491 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6492 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6493 #endif
6494
6495 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6496 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6497 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6498 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6499 #ifdef USE_GTK
6500 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6501 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6502 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6503 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event);
6504 #endif
6505 goto OTHER;
6506
6507 case FocusIn:
6508 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6509 goto OTHER;
6510
6511 case LeaveNotify:
6512 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6513
6514 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6515 if (f)
6516 {
6517 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6518 {
6519 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6520 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6521 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6522 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6523 }
6524
6525 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6526 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6527 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6528 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6529 if (any_help_event_p)
6530 do_help = -1;
6531 }
6532 #ifdef USE_GTK
6533 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6534 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6535 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event);
6536 #endif
6537 goto OTHER;
6538
6539 case FocusOut:
6540 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6541 goto OTHER;
6542
6543 case MotionNotify:
6544 {
6545 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6546 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6547
6548 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6549 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6550 f = last_mouse_frame;
6551 else
6552 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6553
6554 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6555 {
6556 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6557 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6558 }
6559
6560 if (f)
6561 {
6562
6563 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6564 if (mouse_autoselect_window)
6565 {
6566 Lisp_Object window;
6567
6568 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6569 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6570 0, 0, 0, 0);
6571
6572 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6573 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6574 will be selected iff it is active. */
6575 if (WINDOWP (window)
6576 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6577 && !EQ (window, selected_window))
6578 {
6579 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6580 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6581 }
6582
6583 last_window=window;
6584 }
6585 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6586 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6587 }
6588 else
6589 {
6590 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6591 struct scroll_bar *bar
6592 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6593 event.xmotion.window);
6594
6595 if (bar)
6596 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6597 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6598
6599 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6600 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6601 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6602 }
6603
6604 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6605 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6606 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6607 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6608 do_help = 1;
6609 goto OTHER;
6610 }
6611
6612 case ConfigureNotify:
6613 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6614 if (f)
6615 {
6616 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6617 #ifdef USE_GTK
6618 xg_resize_widgets (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6619 event.xconfigure.height);
6620 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6621 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
6622 do this one, the right one will come later.
6623 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
6624 need to reset it below. */
6625 int dont_resize
6626 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6627 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
6628 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6629 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6630
6631 if (dont_resize)
6632 goto OTHER;
6633
6634 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6635 is called by the code that handles resizing
6636 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6637
6638 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6639 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6640 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6641 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6642 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6643 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6644 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6645 {
6646 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6647 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6648 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6649 }
6650 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6651 #endif
6652
6653 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6654 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6655
6656 #ifdef USE_GTK
6657 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6658 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
6659 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6660 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6661 #endif
6662 {
6663 /* What we have now is the position of Emacs's own window.
6664 Convert that to the position of the window manager window. */
6665 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6666
6667 x_check_expected_move (f);
6668 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6669 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
6670 }
6671
6672 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6673 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6674 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6675 #endif
6676
6677 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
6678 {
6679 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
6680 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
6681 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
6682 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
6683 }
6684 }
6685 goto OTHER;
6686
6687 case ButtonRelease:
6688 case ButtonPress:
6689 {
6690 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6691 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6692 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6693
6694 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6695 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6696
6697 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6698 && last_mouse_frame
6699 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6700 f = last_mouse_frame;
6701 else
6702 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6703
6704 if (f)
6705 {
6706 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6707 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6708 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6709 {
6710 Lisp_Object window;
6711 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6712 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6713
6714 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6715 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
6716 {
6717 if (event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress)
6718 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 1, 0);
6719 else
6720 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 0,
6721 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6722 event.xbutton.state));
6723 tool_bar_p = 1;
6724 }
6725 }
6726
6727 if (!tool_bar_p)
6728 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
6729 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6730 {
6731 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6732 if (! popup_activated ())
6733 #endif
6734 {
6735 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6736 {
6737 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6738 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6739 {
6740 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6741 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6742 }
6743 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6744 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6745 }
6746 else
6747 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6748 }
6749 }
6750 }
6751 else
6752 {
6753 struct scroll_bar *bar
6754 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6755 event.xbutton.window);
6756
6757 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6758 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6759 scroll bars. */
6760 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6761 {
6762 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6763 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6764 }
6765 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6766 if (bar)
6767 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6768 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6769 }
6770
6771 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6772 {
6773 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6774 last_mouse_frame = f;
6775
6776 if (!tool_bar_p)
6777 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6778 }
6779 else
6780 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6781
6782 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6783 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6784 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6785 if (f != 0)
6786 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6787
6788 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6789 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6790 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6791 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6792 Instead, save it away
6793 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6794 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6795 if (
6796 #ifdef USE_GTK
6797 ! popup_activated ()
6798 &&
6799 #endif
6800 f && event.type == ButtonPress
6801 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6802 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6803 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6804 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6805 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6806 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6807 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6808 {
6809 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6810 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6811 #ifdef USE_GTK
6812 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6813 #endif
6814 }
6815 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6816 {
6817 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6818 goto OTHER;
6819 }
6820
6821 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6822 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6823 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6824 {
6825 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
6826 {
6827 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
6828 if (f->output_data.x)
6829 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6830 }
6831 else
6832 goto OTHER;
6833 }
6834 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6835 else
6836 goto OTHER;
6837 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6838 }
6839 break;
6840
6841 case CirculateNotify:
6842 goto OTHER;
6843
6844 case CirculateRequest:
6845 goto OTHER;
6846
6847 case VisibilityNotify:
6848 goto OTHER;
6849
6850 case MappingNotify:
6851 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6852 local cache. */
6853 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6854 {
6855 case MappingModifier:
6856 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6857 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6858 case MappingKeyboard:
6859 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6860 }
6861 goto OTHER;
6862
6863 default:
6864 OTHER:
6865 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6866 BLOCK_INPUT;
6867 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6868 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6869 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6870 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6871 break;
6872 }
6873
6874 done:
6875 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
6876 {
6877 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6878 count++;
6879 }
6880
6881 if (do_help
6882 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6883 {
6884 Lisp_Object frame;
6885
6886 if (f)
6887 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6888 else
6889 frame = Qnil;
6890
6891 if (do_help > 0)
6892 {
6893 any_help_event_p = 1;
6894 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6895 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6896 }
6897 else
6898 {
6899 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6900 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6901 }
6902 count++;
6903 }
6904
6905 *eventp = event;
6906 return count;
6907 }
6908
6909
6910 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6911 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6912 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6913
6914 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6915 int
6916 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
6917 XEvent *event;
6918 Display *display;
6919 {
6920 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6921 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6922
6923 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6924
6925 if (dpyinfo)
6926 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6927
6928 return finish;
6929 }
6930
6931
6932 /* Read events coming from the X server.
6933 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
6934 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
6935
6936 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
6937 thus pretending to be `read'.
6938
6939 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
6940
6941 static int
6942 XTread_socket (sd, expected, hold_quit)
6943 register int sd;
6944 int expected;
6945 struct input_event *hold_quit;
6946 {
6947 int count = 0;
6948 XEvent event;
6949 int event_found = 0;
6950 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6951
6952 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
6953 {
6954 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
6955 return -1;
6956 }
6957
6958 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
6959 BLOCK_INPUT;
6960
6961 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
6962 input_signal_count++;
6963
6964 ++handling_signal;
6965
6966 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
6967 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
6968 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
6969 {
6970 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
6971 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
6972 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
6973 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
6974 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
6975 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
6976 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
6977 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
6978 #endif
6979
6980 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
6981 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
6982 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
6983 for X connections. */
6984 #ifndef SIGIO
6985 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
6986 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
6987 {
6988 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
6989 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
6990 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
6991 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
6992 }
6993 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
6994 #endif /* SIGIO */
6995 #endif
6996
6997 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
6998 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
6999 {
7000 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7001 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
7002 }
7003
7004 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7005 {
7006 struct input_event inev;
7007 BLOCK_INPUT;
7008 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7009 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7010 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
7011 {
7012 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
7013 count++;
7014 }
7015 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7016 }
7017 #endif
7018
7019 #ifndef USE_GTK
7020 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
7021 {
7022 int finish;
7023
7024 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7025
7026 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7027 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7028 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
7029 break;
7030 #endif
7031 event_found = 1;
7032
7033 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7034
7035 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7036 goto out;
7037 }
7038 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7039 }
7040
7041 #ifdef USE_GTK
7042
7043 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7044 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7045 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7046 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7047
7048 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7049 from all displays. */
7050
7051 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7052 {
7053 current_count = count;
7054 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7055
7056 gtk_main_iteration ();
7057
7058 count = current_count;
7059 current_count = -1;
7060 current_hold_quit = 0;
7061
7062 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7063 break;
7064 }
7065 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7066
7067 out:;
7068
7069 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7070 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7071 if (! event_found)
7072 {
7073 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7074 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7075 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7076 x_noop_count++;
7077 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7078 {
7079 x_noop_count=0;
7080
7081 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7082 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7083
7084 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7085
7086 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7087 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7088 }
7089 }
7090
7091 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7092 raise it now. */
7093 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7094 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7095 {
7096 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7097 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7098 }
7099
7100 --handling_signal;
7101 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7102
7103 return count;
7104 }
7105
7106
7107
7108 \f
7109 /***********************************************************************
7110 Text Cursor
7111 ***********************************************************************/
7112
7113 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7114 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7115
7116 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7117 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7118 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7119
7120 static void
7121 x_clip_to_row (w, row, area, gc)
7122 struct window *w;
7123 struct glyph_row *row;
7124 int area;
7125 GC gc;
7126 {
7127 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7128 XRectangle clip_rect;
7129 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7130
7131 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7132
7133 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7134 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7135 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7136 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7137 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7138
7139 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7140 }
7141
7142
7143 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7144
7145 static void
7146 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7147 struct window *w;
7148 struct glyph_row *row;
7149 {
7150 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7151 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7152 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7153 int x, y, wd, h;
7154 XGCValues xgcv;
7155 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7156 GC gc;
7157
7158 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7159 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7160 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7161 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7162 return;
7163
7164 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7165 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7166 y = get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &h);
7167 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7168
7169 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7170 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7171 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7172 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7173 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7174 else
7175 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7176 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7177 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7178
7179 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7180 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7181 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h);
7182 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7183 }
7184
7185
7186 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7187
7188 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7189 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7190 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7191 --gerd. */
7192
7193 static void
7194 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7195 struct window *w;
7196 struct glyph_row *row;
7197 int width;
7198 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7199 {
7200 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7201 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7202
7203 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7204 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7205 and mini-buffer. */
7206 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7207 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7208 return;
7209
7210 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7211 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7212 the bar might not be in the window. */
7213 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7214 {
7215 struct glyph_row *row;
7216 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7217 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7218 }
7219 else
7220 {
7221 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7222 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7223 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7224 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7225 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7226 XGCValues xgcv;
7227
7228 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7229 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7230 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7231 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7232 that the glyph is legible. */
7233 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7234 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7235 else
7236 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7237 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7238
7239 if (gc)
7240 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7241 else
7242 {
7243 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7244 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7245 }
7246
7247 if (width < 0)
7248 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7249 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7250
7251 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7252 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7253
7254 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7255 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7256 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7257 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7258 width, row->height);
7259 else
7260 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7261 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7262 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7263 row->height - width),
7264 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
7265 width);
7266
7267 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7268 }
7269 }
7270
7271
7272 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7273
7274 static void
7275 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7276 struct frame *f;
7277 Cursor cursor;
7278 {
7279 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7280 }
7281
7282
7283 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7284
7285 static void
7286 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7287 struct frame *f;
7288 int x, y, width, height;
7289 {
7290 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7291 x, y, width, height, False);
7292 }
7293
7294
7295 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7296
7297 static void
7298 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7299 struct window *w;
7300 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7301 int x, y;
7302 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7303 int on_p, active_p;
7304 {
7305 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7306
7307 if (on_p)
7308 {
7309 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7310 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7311
7312 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7313 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7314 {
7315 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7316 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, 0);
7317 }
7318 else
7319 switch (cursor_type)
7320 {
7321 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7322 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7323 break;
7324
7325 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7326 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7327 break;
7328
7329 case BAR_CURSOR:
7330 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7331 break;
7332
7333 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7334 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7335 break;
7336
7337 case NO_CURSOR:
7338 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7339 break;
7340
7341 default:
7342 abort ();
7343 }
7344
7345 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7346 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7347 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7348 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7349 #endif
7350 }
7351
7352 #ifndef XFlush
7353 if (updating_frame != f)
7354 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7355 #endif
7356 }
7357
7358 \f
7359 /* Icons. */
7360
7361 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7362
7363 int
7364 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7365 struct frame *f;
7366 Lisp_Object file;
7367 {
7368 int bitmap_id;
7369
7370 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7371 return 1;
7372
7373 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7374 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7375 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7376 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7377
7378 if (STRINGP (file))
7379 {
7380 #ifdef USE_GTK
7381 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7382 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7383 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7384 return 0;
7385 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7386 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7387 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7388 }
7389 else
7390 {
7391 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7392 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7393 {
7394 int rc = -1;
7395
7396 #if defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7397 #ifdef USE_GTK
7398 if (xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7399 return 0;
7400 #else
7401 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7402 if (rc != -1)
7403 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7404 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7405 #endif /* defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS) */
7406
7407 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7408 if (rc == -1)
7409 {
7410 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_xbm_bits,
7411 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7412 if (rc == -1)
7413 return 1;
7414
7415 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7416 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7417 }
7418 }
7419
7420 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7421 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7422 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7423 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7424 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7425
7426 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7427 }
7428
7429 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7430 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7431
7432 return 0;
7433 }
7434
7435
7436 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7437 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7438
7439 int
7440 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7441 struct frame *f;
7442 char *icon_name;
7443 {
7444 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7445 return 1;
7446
7447 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
7448 {
7449 XTextProperty text;
7450 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7451 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7452 text.format = 8;
7453 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7454 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7455 }
7456 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7457 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
7458 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7459
7460 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7461 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7462 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7463 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7464
7465 return 0;
7466 }
7467 \f
7468 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7469
7470 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7471 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7472
7473 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7474 be called from a signal handler.
7475 */
7476
7477 struct x_error_message_stack {
7478 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7479 Display *dpy;
7480 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7481 };
7482 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7483
7484 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7485 x_error_message_string. This is called from x_error_handler if
7486 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7487
7488 static void
7489 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7490 Display *display;
7491 XErrorEvent *error;
7492 {
7493 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7494 x_error_message->string,
7495 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7496 }
7497
7498 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7499 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7500 operating on.
7501
7502 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7503 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7504 stored in x_error_message_string.
7505
7506 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7507 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7508
7509 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7510
7511 void x_check_errors ();
7512
7513 void
7514 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7515 Display *dpy;
7516 {
7517 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7518
7519 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7520 XSync (dpy, False);
7521
7522 data->dpy = dpy;
7523 data->string[0] = 0;
7524 data->prev = x_error_message;
7525 x_error_message = data;
7526 }
7527
7528 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7529 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7530
7531 void
7532 x_uncatch_errors ()
7533 {
7534 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7535
7536 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7537 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7538 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7539 {
7540 BLOCK_INPUT;
7541 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7542 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7543 }
7544
7545 tmp = x_error_message;
7546 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7547 xfree (tmp);
7548 }
7549
7550 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7551 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7552 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7553
7554 void
7555 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7556 Display *dpy;
7557 char *format;
7558 {
7559 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7560 XSync (dpy, False);
7561
7562 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7563 {
7564 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7565 bcopy (x_error_message->string, string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7566 x_uncatch_errors ();
7567 error (format, string);
7568 }
7569 }
7570
7571 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7572 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7573
7574 int
7575 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7576 Display *dpy;
7577 {
7578 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7579 XSync (dpy, False);
7580
7581 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7582 }
7583
7584 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7585
7586 void
7587 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7588 Display *dpy;
7589 {
7590 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7591 }
7592
7593 #if 0
7594 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7595 x_trace_wire ()
7596 {
7597 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7598 }
7599 #endif /* ! 0 */
7600
7601 \f
7602 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7603 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7604 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7605 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7606 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7607
7608 static SIGTYPE
7609 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7610 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7611 {
7612 #ifdef USG
7613 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7614 must reestablish each time */
7615 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7616 #endif /* USG */
7617 }
7618
7619 \f
7620 /************************************************************************
7621 Handling X errors
7622 ************************************************************************/
7623
7624 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7625
7626 static char *error_msg;
7627
7628 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7629 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7630 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7631
7632 static void
7633 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7634 {
7635 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7636 exit (70);
7637 }
7638
7639 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7640 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7641
7642 static SIGTYPE
7643 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
7644 Display *dpy;
7645 char *error_message;
7646 {
7647 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7648 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7649
7650 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7651 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7652 handling_signal = 0;
7653
7654 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7655 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7656 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7657 the original message here. */
7658 x_catch_errors (dpy);
7659
7660 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7661 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7662 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7663
7664 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7665 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7666 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7667
7668 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7669 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
7670
7671 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7672 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7673 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
7674
7675 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7676 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7677 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7678 if (dpyinfo)
7679 {
7680 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
7681 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7682 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7683 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7684 }
7685 #endif
7686
7687 #ifdef USE_GTK
7688 if (dpyinfo)
7689 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
7690 #endif
7691
7692 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7693 if (dpyinfo)
7694 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7695
7696 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7697 that are on the dead display. */
7698 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7699 {
7700 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7701 minibuf_frame
7702 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7703 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7704 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7705 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7706 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7707 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7708 }
7709
7710 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7711 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7712 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7713 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7714 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7715 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7716 {
7717 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
7718 trying to find a replacement. */
7719 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7720 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7721 }
7722
7723 if (dpyinfo)
7724 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
7725
7726 x_uncatch_errors ();
7727
7728 if (x_display_list == 0)
7729 {
7730 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7731 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7732 exit (70);
7733 }
7734
7735 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7736 #ifdef SIGIO
7737 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7738 #endif
7739 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7740 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7741
7742 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7743 error ("%s", error_msg);
7744 }
7745
7746 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7747 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7748 static void x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error);
7749
7750 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7751 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7752
7753 static int
7754 x_error_handler (display, error)
7755 Display *display;
7756 XErrorEvent *error;
7757 {
7758 if (x_error_message)
7759 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7760 else
7761 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7762 return 0;
7763 }
7764
7765 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7766 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7767 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7768
7769 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7770
7771 #if __GNUC__ >= 3 /* On GCC 3.0 we might get a warning. */
7772 #define NO_INLINE __attribute__((noinline))
7773 #else
7774 #define NO_INLINE
7775 #endif
7776
7777 /* Some versions of GNU/Linux define noinline in their headers. */
7778
7779 #ifdef noinline
7780 #undef noinline
7781 #endif
7782
7783 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7784 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7785
7786 static void NO_INLINE
7787 x_error_quitter (display, error)
7788 Display *display;
7789 XErrorEvent *error;
7790 {
7791 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7792
7793 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7794 original error handler. */
7795
7796 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7797 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7798 buf, error->request_code);
7799 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7800 }
7801
7802
7803 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7804 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7805 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7806
7807 static int
7808 x_io_error_quitter (display)
7809 Display *display;
7810 {
7811 char buf[256];
7812
7813 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7814 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7815 return 0;
7816 }
7817 \f
7818 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7819
7820 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
7821 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
7822 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
7823 The return value shows which font we chose. */
7824
7825 Lisp_Object
7826 x_new_font (f, fontname)
7827 struct frame *f;
7828 register char *fontname;
7829 {
7830 struct font_info *fontp
7831 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
7832
7833 if (!fontp)
7834 return Qnil;
7835
7836 FRAME_FONT (f) = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
7837 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = fontp->baseline_offset;
7838 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = -1;
7839
7840 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = fontp->average_width;
7841 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = fontp->space_width;
7842 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
7843
7844 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7845
7846 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7847 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7848 {
7849 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7850 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7851 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7852 }
7853 else
7854 {
7855 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7856 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7857 }
7858
7859 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
7860 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7861 {
7862 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
7863 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7864 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
7865 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7866 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
7867 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7868
7869 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7870 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7871 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7872 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7873 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7874 }
7875
7876 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
7877 }
7878
7879 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
7880 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
7881 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
7882 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
7883
7884 Lisp_Object
7885 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
7886 struct frame *f;
7887 char *fontsetname;
7888 {
7889 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
7890 Lisp_Object result;
7891
7892 if (fontset < 0)
7893 return Qnil;
7894
7895 if (FRAME_FONTSET (f) == fontset)
7896 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
7897 to do. */
7898 return fontset_name (fontset);
7899
7900 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
7901
7902 if (!STRINGP (result))
7903 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
7904 return Qnil;
7905
7906 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
7907 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7908
7909 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7910 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7911 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7912 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7913 #endif
7914
7915 return build_string (fontsetname);
7916 }
7917
7918 \f
7919 /***********************************************************************
7920 X Input Methods
7921 ***********************************************************************/
7922
7923 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7924
7925 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7926
7927 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7928 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7929 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7930
7931 static void
7932 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
7933 XIM xim;
7934 XPointer client_data;
7935 XPointer call_data;
7936 {
7937 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7938 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7939
7940 BLOCK_INPUT;
7941
7942 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7943 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7944 {
7945 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7946 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7947 {
7948 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7949 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7950 }
7951 }
7952
7953 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7954 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7955 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7956 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7957 }
7958
7959 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7960
7961 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7962 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7963 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
7964 #endif
7965
7966 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7967 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7968
7969 static void
7970 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
7971 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7972 char *resource_name;
7973 {
7974 XIM xim;
7975
7976 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7977 if (use_xim)
7978 {
7979 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
7980 EMACS_CLASS);
7981 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
7982
7983 if (xim)
7984 {
7985 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7986 XIMCallback destroy;
7987 #endif
7988
7989 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
7990 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
7991
7992 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7993 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
7994 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
7995 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
7996 #endif
7997 }
7998 }
7999
8000 else
8001 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8002 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8003 }
8004
8005
8006 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8007
8008 struct xim_inst_t
8009 {
8010 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8011 char *resource_name;
8012 };
8013
8014 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8015 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8016 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8017 when the callback was registered. */
8018
8019 static void
8020 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
8021 Display *display;
8022 XPointer client_data;
8023 XPointer call_data;
8024 {
8025 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8026 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8027
8028 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8029 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8030 return;
8031
8032 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8033
8034 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8035 as they have no XIC. */
8036 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8037 {
8038 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8039
8040 BLOCK_INPUT;
8041 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8042 {
8043 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8044
8045 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8046 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8047 {
8048 create_frame_xic (f);
8049 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8050 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8051 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8052 {
8053 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8054 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8055 }
8056 }
8057 }
8058
8059 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8060 }
8061 }
8062
8063 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8064
8065
8066 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8067 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8068 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8069 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8070
8071 static void
8072 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8073 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8074 char *resource_name;
8075 {
8076 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8077 if (use_xim)
8078 {
8079 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8080 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8081 int len;
8082
8083 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8084 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8085 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8086 len = strlen (resource_name);
8087 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8088 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8089 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8090 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8091 xim_instantiate_callback,
8092 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8093 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8094 least, hence the configure test. */
8095 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8096 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8097 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8098 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8099 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8100
8101 }
8102 else
8103 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8104 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8105 }
8106
8107
8108 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8109
8110 static void
8111 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8112 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8113 {
8114 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8115 if (use_xim)
8116 {
8117 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8118 if (dpyinfo->display)
8119 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8120 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8121 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8122 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8123 if (dpyinfo->display)
8124 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8125 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8126 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8127 }
8128 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8129 }
8130
8131 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8132
8133
8134 \f
8135 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8136 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8137
8138 void
8139 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8140 struct frame *f;
8141 {
8142 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8143
8144 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8145 is already for the top-left corner. */
8146 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8147 return;
8148
8149 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8150 position that fits on the screen. */
8151 if (flags & XNegative)
8152 f->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
8153 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos);
8154
8155 {
8156 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8157
8158 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8159 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8160 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8161
8162 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8163 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8164 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8165 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8166 is right, though.
8167
8168 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8169 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8170
8171 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8172 #endif
8173
8174 if (flags & YNegative)
8175 f->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - height + f->top_pos);
8176 }
8177
8178 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8179 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8180 so the flags should correspond. */
8181 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8182 }
8183
8184 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8185 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8186 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8187 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8188 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8189
8190 void
8191 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8192 struct frame *f;
8193 register int xoff, yoff;
8194 int change_gravity;
8195 {
8196 int modified_top, modified_left;
8197
8198 if (change_gravity > 0)
8199 {
8200 f->top_pos = yoff;
8201 f->left_pos = xoff;
8202 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8203 if (xoff < 0)
8204 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8205 if (yoff < 0)
8206 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8207 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8208 }
8209 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8210
8211 BLOCK_INPUT;
8212 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8213
8214 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8215 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8216
8217 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8218 {
8219 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8220 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8221 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8222 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8223 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8224 }
8225
8226 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8227 modified_left, modified_top);
8228
8229 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
8230 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8231 {
8232 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 1;
8233 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top = f->top_pos;
8234 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left = f->left_pos;
8235 }
8236
8237 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8238 }
8239
8240 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8241 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8242 static void
8243 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8244 struct frame *f;
8245 {
8246 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8247 {
8248 int width, height, ign;
8249
8250 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8251
8252 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8253
8254 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8255 when setting WM manager hints.
8256 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8257 x_check_expected_move. */
8258 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8259 {
8260 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8261 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8262 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8263
8264 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8265 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
8266 }
8267 }
8268 }
8269
8270 /* If frame parameters are set after the frame is mapped, we need to move
8271 the window.
8272 Some window managers moves the window to the right position, some
8273 moves the outer window manager window to the specified position.
8274 Here we check that we are in the right spot. If not, make a second
8275 move, assuming we are dealing with the second kind of window manager. */
8276 static void
8277 x_check_expected_move (f)
8278 struct frame *f;
8279 {
8280 if (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move)
8281 {
8282 int expect_top = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top;
8283 int expect_left = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left;
8284
8285 if (expect_top != f->top_pos || expect_left != f->left_pos)
8286 {
8287 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8288 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expect_left - f->left_pos;
8289 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expect_top - f->top_pos;
8290
8291 f->left_pos = expect_left;
8292 f->top_pos = expect_top;
8293 x_set_offset (f, expect_left, expect_top, 0);
8294 }
8295 else if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8296 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8297
8298 /* Just do this once */
8299 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 0;
8300 }
8301 }
8302
8303
8304 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8305 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8306 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8307 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8308
8309 static void
8310 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8311 struct frame *f;
8312 int change_gravity;
8313 int cols, rows;
8314 {
8315 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8316
8317 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8318 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8319 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8320 ? 0
8321 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
8322 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
8323 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
8324
8325 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8326
8327 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
8328 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
8329
8330 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8331 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8332
8333 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8334 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8335 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8336
8337 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8338 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8339 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8340 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8341
8342 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8343 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8344 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8345 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8346 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8347
8348 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8349 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8350 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8351 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8352 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8353
8354 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8355 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8356 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8357 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8358 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8359
8360 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8361 }
8362
8363
8364 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8365 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8366 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8367 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8368
8369 void
8370 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8371 struct frame *f;
8372 int change_gravity;
8373 int cols, rows;
8374 {
8375 BLOCK_INPUT;
8376
8377 #ifdef USE_GTK
8378 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8379 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8380 else
8381 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8382 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
8383
8384 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
8385 {
8386 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
8387 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
8388 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
8389 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
8390 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
8391 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
8392 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
8393 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
8394 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
8395 }
8396 else
8397 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8398
8399 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8400
8401 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8402
8403 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8404
8405 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8406 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8407
8408 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8409 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8410 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8411 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8412 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8413
8414 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8415 }
8416 \f
8417 /* Mouse warping. */
8418
8419 void
8420 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
8421 struct frame *f;
8422 int x, y;
8423 {
8424 int pix_x, pix_y;
8425
8426 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8427 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8428
8429 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8430 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8431
8432 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8433 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8434
8435 BLOCK_INPUT;
8436
8437 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8438 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8439 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8440 }
8441
8442 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8443
8444 void
8445 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
8446 struct frame *f;
8447 int pix_x, pix_y;
8448 {
8449 BLOCK_INPUT;
8450
8451 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8452 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8453 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8454 }
8455 \f
8456 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8457
8458 void
8459 x_focus_on_frame (f)
8460 struct frame *f;
8461 {
8462 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
8463 x_raise_frame (f);
8464 #endif
8465 #if 0
8466 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8467 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8468 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8469 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8470 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8471 #endif /* ! 0 */
8472 }
8473
8474 void
8475 x_unfocus_frame (f)
8476 struct frame *f;
8477 {
8478 #if 0
8479 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8480 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8481 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8482 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8483 #endif /* ! 0 */
8484 }
8485
8486 /* Raise frame F. */
8487
8488 void
8489 x_raise_frame (f)
8490 struct frame *f;
8491 {
8492 if (f->async_visible)
8493 {
8494 BLOCK_INPUT;
8495 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8496 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8497 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8498 }
8499 }
8500
8501 /* Lower frame F. */
8502
8503 void
8504 x_lower_frame (f)
8505 struct frame *f;
8506 {
8507 if (f->async_visible)
8508 {
8509 BLOCK_INPUT;
8510 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8511 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8512 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8513 }
8514 }
8515
8516 static void
8517 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
8518 FRAME_PTR f;
8519 int raise_flag;
8520 {
8521 if (raise_flag)
8522 x_raise_frame (f);
8523 else
8524 x_lower_frame (f);
8525 }
8526 \f
8527 /* Change of visibility. */
8528
8529 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8530 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8531 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8532 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8533 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8534 finishes with it. */
8535
8536 void
8537 x_make_frame_visible (f)
8538 struct frame *f;
8539 {
8540 Lisp_Object type;
8541 int original_top, original_left;
8542 int retry_count = 2;
8543
8544 retry:
8545
8546 BLOCK_INPUT;
8547
8548 type = x_icon_type (f);
8549 if (!NILP (type))
8550 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8551
8552 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8553 {
8554 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8555 call x_set_offset a second time
8556 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8557 before the window gets really visible. */
8558 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8559 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8560 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8561
8562 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8563
8564 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8565 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8566 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8567 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8568 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8569 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8570 #ifdef USE_GTK
8571 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8572 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8573 #else
8574 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8575 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8576 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8577 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
8578 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
8579 to come back ok without this. */
8580 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
8581 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8582 #endif
8583 }
8584
8585 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8586
8587 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8588 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8589 so that incoming events are handled. */
8590 {
8591 Lisp_Object frame;
8592 int count;
8593 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8594 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8595 will set it when they are handled. */
8596 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
8597
8598 original_left = f->left_pos;
8599 original_top = f->top_pos;
8600
8601 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
8602 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8603
8604 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
8605
8606 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
8607 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
8608 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
8609 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
8610
8611 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
8612 because the window manager may choose the position
8613 and we don't want to override it. */
8614
8615 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8616 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
8617 && previously_visible)
8618 {
8619 Drawable rootw;
8620 int x, y;
8621 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
8622
8623 BLOCK_INPUT;
8624
8625 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
8626 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
8627 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
8628 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
8629 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
8630 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
8631 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
8632 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8633 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
8634
8635 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
8636 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8637 original_left, original_top);
8638
8639 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8640 }
8641
8642 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8643
8644 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
8645 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
8646 MapNotify at all.. */
8647 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
8648 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
8649 {
8650 /* Force processing of queued events. */
8651 x_sync (f);
8652
8653 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
8654 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
8655 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
8656 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
8657 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
8658 probably a bug. */
8659 if (input_polling_used ())
8660 {
8661 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
8662 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
8663 handler reset it. */
8664 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
8665 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
8666 poll_suppress_count = 1;
8667 poll_for_input_1 ();
8668 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
8669 }
8670
8671 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
8672 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8673 }
8674
8675 /* 2000-09-28: In
8676
8677 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
8678 (iconify-frame f)
8679 (raise-frame f))
8680
8681 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
8682 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
8683 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
8684 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
8685
8686 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
8687 goto retry;
8688 }
8689 }
8690
8691 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
8692
8693 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
8694
8695 void
8696 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
8697 struct frame *f;
8698 {
8699 Window window;
8700
8701 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
8702 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
8703
8704 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8705 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8706 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8707
8708 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
8709 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
8710 return;
8711 #endif
8712
8713 BLOCK_INPUT;
8714
8715 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
8716 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
8717 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
8718 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
8719 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
8720 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
8721
8722 #ifdef USE_GTK
8723 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8724 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8725 else
8726 #endif
8727 {
8728 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
8729
8730 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
8731 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
8732 {
8733 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8734 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
8735 }
8736 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8737
8738 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
8739 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8740 {
8741 XEvent unmap;
8742
8743 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
8744 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
8745 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8746 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
8747 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8748 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8749 False,
8750 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
8751 &unmap))
8752 {
8753 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8754 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
8755 }
8756 }
8757
8758 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
8759 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
8760 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8761 }
8762
8763 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
8764 just by the event that we get from the server.
8765 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
8766 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
8767 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
8768 f->visible = 0;
8769 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
8770 f->async_visible = 0;
8771 f->async_iconified = 0;
8772
8773 x_sync (f);
8774
8775 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8776 }
8777
8778 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
8779
8780 void
8781 x_iconify_frame (f)
8782 struct frame *f;
8783 {
8784 int result;
8785 Lisp_Object type;
8786
8787 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8788 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8789 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8790
8791 if (f->async_iconified)
8792 return;
8793
8794 BLOCK_INPUT;
8795
8796 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8797
8798 type = x_icon_type (f);
8799 if (!NILP (type))
8800 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8801
8802 #ifdef USE_GTK
8803 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8804 {
8805 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8806 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8807
8808 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8809 f->iconified = 1;
8810 f->visible = 1;
8811 f->async_iconified = 1;
8812 f->async_visible = 0;
8813 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8814 return;
8815 }
8816 #endif
8817
8818 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8819
8820 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8821 {
8822 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8823 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8824 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8825 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8826 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
8827 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
8828 so we have to record it here. */
8829 f->iconified = 1;
8830 f->visible = 1;
8831 f->async_iconified = 1;
8832 f->async_visible = 0;
8833 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8834 return;
8835 }
8836
8837 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8838 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
8839 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
8840 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8841
8842 if (!result)
8843 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8844
8845 f->async_iconified = 1;
8846 f->async_visible = 0;
8847
8848
8849 BLOCK_INPUT;
8850 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8851 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8852 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8853
8854 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
8855 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
8856 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
8857 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8858
8859 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
8860 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
8861
8862 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
8863 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
8864 {
8865 XEvent message;
8866
8867 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
8868 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8869 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
8870 message.xclient.format = 32;
8871 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
8872
8873 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8874 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8875 False,
8876 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
8877 &message))
8878 {
8879 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8880 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8881 }
8882 }
8883
8884 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
8885 IconicState. */
8886 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8887
8888 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8889 {
8890 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
8891 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8892 }
8893
8894 f->async_iconified = 1;
8895 f->async_visible = 0;
8896
8897 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8898 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8899 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8900 }
8901
8902 \f
8903 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
8904
8905 void
8906 x_free_frame_resources (f)
8907 struct frame *f;
8908 {
8909 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8910 Lisp_Object bar;
8911 struct scroll_bar *b;
8912
8913 BLOCK_INPUT;
8914
8915 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
8916 commands to the X server. */
8917 if (dpyinfo->display)
8918 {
8919 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
8920 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
8921
8922 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8923 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
8924 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
8925 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
8926 toolkit scroll bars. */
8927 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
8928 {
8929 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
8930 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
8931 }
8932 #endif
8933
8934 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8935 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
8936 free_frame_xic (f);
8937 #endif
8938
8939 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8940 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
8941 {
8942 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8943 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
8944 }
8945 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
8946 we are using a toolkit. */
8947 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8948 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8949
8950 free_frame_menubar (f);
8951 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8952
8953 #ifdef USE_GTK
8954 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
8955 frames. We must check and free both types. */
8956 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8957 {
8958 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8959 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
8960 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
8961 }
8962 #endif /* USE_GTK */
8963
8964 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8965 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8966 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8967
8968 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
8969 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
8970 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
8971 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
8972 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
8973 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
8974
8975 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
8976 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
8977 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
8978 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
8979 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8980 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
8981 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
8982 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
8983 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
8984 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
8985 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8986 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
8987 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
8988 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
8989 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
8990
8991 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
8992 free_frame_faces (f);
8993
8994 x_free_gcs (f);
8995 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8996 }
8997
8998 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
8999 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9000
9001 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9002 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9003
9004 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9005 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9006 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9007 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9008 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9009 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9010
9011 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9012 {
9013 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9014 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9015 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9016 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9017 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9018 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9019 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9020 }
9021
9022 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9023 }
9024
9025
9026 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9027
9028 void
9029 x_destroy_window (f)
9030 struct frame *f;
9031 {
9032 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9033
9034 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9035 commands to the X server. */
9036 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9037 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9038
9039 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9040 }
9041
9042 \f
9043 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9044
9045 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9046 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9047 that the window now has.
9048 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9049 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9050 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9051
9052 #ifndef USE_GTK
9053 void
9054 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9055 struct frame *f;
9056 long flags;
9057 int user_position;
9058 {
9059 XSizeHints size_hints;
9060
9061 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9062 Arg al[2];
9063 int ac = 0;
9064 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9065 #endif
9066
9067 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9068
9069 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9070 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9071
9072 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9073 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9074
9075 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9076 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9077 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9078 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9079 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9080 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9081 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9082 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9083 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9084 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9085
9086 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9087 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9088 size_hints.max_width
9089 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9090 size_hints.max_height
9091 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9092
9093 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9094
9095 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9096 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9097 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9098 {
9099 int base_width, base_height;
9100 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9101
9102 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9103 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9104
9105 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9106
9107 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9108 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9109 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9110 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9111 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9112
9113 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9114 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9115 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9116
9117 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9118 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9119 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9120 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9121 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9122 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9123 #else
9124 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
9125 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
9126 #endif
9127 }
9128
9129 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9130 if (flags)
9131 {
9132 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9133 goto no_read;
9134 }
9135 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9136
9137 {
9138 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9139 long supplied_return;
9140 int value;
9141
9142 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9143 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9144 &supplied_return);
9145 #else
9146 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
9147 #endif
9148
9149 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9150 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
9151 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
9152 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
9153 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
9154 #endif
9155
9156 if (flags)
9157 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9158 else
9159 {
9160 if (value == 0)
9161 hints.flags = 0;
9162 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9163 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9164 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9165 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9166 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9167 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9168 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9169 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9170 }
9171 }
9172
9173 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9174 no_read:
9175 #endif
9176
9177 #ifdef PWinGravity
9178 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9179 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9180
9181 if (user_position)
9182 {
9183 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9184 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9185 }
9186 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9187
9188 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9189 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9190 #else
9191 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9192 #endif
9193 }
9194 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9195
9196 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9197
9198 void
9199 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
9200 struct frame *f;
9201 int state;
9202 {
9203 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9204 Arg al[1];
9205
9206 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9207 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9208 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9209 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9210
9211 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9212 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9213
9214 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9215 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9216 }
9217
9218 void
9219 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
9220 struct frame *f;
9221 int pixmap_id;
9222 {
9223 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9224
9225 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9226 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9227 #endif
9228
9229 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9230 {
9231 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9232 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9233 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9234 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9235 }
9236 else
9237 {
9238 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
9239 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
9240 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
9241 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
9242 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
9243 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
9244 best to explicitly give up. */
9245 #if 0
9246 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
9247 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = None;
9248 #else
9249 return;
9250 #endif
9251 }
9252
9253
9254 #ifdef USE_GTK
9255 {
9256 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9257 return;
9258 }
9259
9260 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9261
9262 {
9263 Arg al[1];
9264 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9265 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9266 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9267 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9268 }
9269
9270 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9271
9272 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9273 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9274
9275 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9276 }
9277
9278 void
9279 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
9280 struct frame *f;
9281 int icon_x, icon_y;
9282 {
9283 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9284
9285 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9286 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9287 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9288
9289 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9290 }
9291
9292 \f
9293 /***********************************************************************
9294 Fonts
9295 ***********************************************************************/
9296
9297 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
9298
9299 struct font_info *
9300 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
9301 FRAME_PTR f;
9302 int font_idx;
9303 {
9304 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
9305 }
9306
9307
9308 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
9309
9310 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
9311 to be listed.
9312
9313 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
9314
9315 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
9316 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
9317 on how many fonts to match. */
9318
9319 Lisp_Object
9320 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
9321 struct frame *f;
9322 Lisp_Object pattern;
9323 int size;
9324 int maxnames;
9325 {
9326 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
9327 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
9328 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
9329 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
9330 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
9331 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9332 int allow_auto_scaled_font = 0;
9333
9334 if (size < 0)
9335 {
9336 allow_auto_scaled_font = 1;
9337 size = 0;
9338 }
9339
9340 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
9341 if (NILP (patterns))
9342 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
9343
9344 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
9345 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
9346 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
9347
9348 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
9349 {
9350 int num_fonts;
9351 char **names = NULL;
9352
9353 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
9354 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
9355 The cache is an alist of the form:
9356 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
9357 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
9358 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
9359 allow_auto_scaled_font ? Qt : Qnil);
9360 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
9361 if (!NILP (list))
9362 {
9363 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
9364 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
9365 goto label_cached;
9366 }
9367
9368 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
9369
9370 BLOCK_INPUT;
9371 x_catch_errors (dpy);
9372
9373 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
9374 {
9375 XFontStruct *font;
9376 unsigned long value;
9377
9378 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
9379 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9380 {
9381 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9382 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9383 font = NULL;
9384 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9385 }
9386
9387 if (font
9388 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9389 {
9390 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
9391 int len = strlen (name);
9392 char *tmp;
9393
9394 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
9395 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
9396 string. We must avoid such a name. */
9397 if (len == 0)
9398 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9399 else
9400 {
9401 num_fonts = 1;
9402 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
9403 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
9404 simple var. */
9405 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
9406 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
9407 XFree (name);
9408 }
9409 }
9410 else
9411 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9412
9413 if (font)
9414 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
9415 }
9416
9417 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9418 {
9419 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
9420 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
9421 if (maxnames < 0)
9422 {
9423 int limit;
9424
9425 for (limit = 500;;)
9426 {
9427 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), limit, &num_fonts);
9428 if (num_fonts == limit)
9429 {
9430 BLOCK_INPUT;
9431 XFreeFontNames (names);
9432 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9433 limit *= 2;
9434 }
9435 else
9436 break;
9437 }
9438 }
9439 else
9440 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
9441 &num_fonts);
9442
9443 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9444 {
9445 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9446 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9447 names = NULL;
9448 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9449 }
9450 }
9451
9452 x_uncatch_errors ();
9453 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9454
9455 if (names)
9456 {
9457 int i;
9458
9459 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
9460 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
9461 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
9462 {
9463 int width = 0;
9464 char *p = names[i];
9465 int average_width = -1, resx = 0, dashes = 0;
9466
9467 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
9468 14 dashes, the field value following 9th dash
9469 (RESOLUTION_X) is nonzero, and the field value
9470 following 12th dash (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a
9471 auto-scaled font which is usually too ugly to be used
9472 for editing. Let's ignore it. */
9473 while (*p)
9474 if (*p++ == '-')
9475 {
9476 dashes++;
9477 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
9478 width = atoi (p);
9479 else if (dashes == 9)
9480 resx = atoi (p);
9481 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
9482 average_width = atoi (p);
9483 }
9484
9485 if (allow_auto_scaled_font
9486 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0 || resx == 0)
9487 {
9488 tem = build_string (names[i]);
9489 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
9490 {
9491 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
9492 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
9493 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
9494 >= 0))
9495 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
9496 width of this font. */
9497 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
9498 else
9499 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
9500 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
9501 }
9502 }
9503 }
9504
9505 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9506 {
9507 BLOCK_INPUT;
9508 XFreeFontNames (names);
9509 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9510 }
9511 }
9512
9513 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
9514 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9515 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9516
9517 label_cached:
9518 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
9519
9520 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
9521 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
9522 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9523 {
9524 int found_size;
9525
9526 tem = XCAR (list);
9527
9528 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
9529 continue;
9530 if (!size)
9531 {
9532 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9533 continue;
9534 }
9535
9536 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
9537 {
9538 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
9539 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
9540 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
9541
9542 BLOCK_INPUT;
9543 x_catch_errors (dpy);
9544 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
9545 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
9546 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9547 {
9548 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9549 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9550 thisinfo = NULL;
9551 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9552 }
9553 x_uncatch_errors ();
9554 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9555
9556 if (thisinfo)
9557 {
9558 XSETCDR (tem,
9559 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
9560 ? make_number (0)
9561 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
9562 BLOCK_INPUT;
9563 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
9564 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9565 }
9566 else
9567 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
9568 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
9569 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
9570 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
9571 }
9572
9573 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
9574 if (found_size == size)
9575 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9576 else if (found_size > 0)
9577 {
9578 if (NILP (second_best))
9579 second_best = tem;
9580 else if (found_size < size)
9581 {
9582 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9583 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
9584 second_best = tem;
9585 }
9586 else
9587 {
9588 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9589 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
9590 second_best = tem;
9591 }
9592 }
9593 }
9594 if (!NILP (newlist))
9595 break;
9596 else if (!NILP (second_best))
9597 {
9598 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
9599 break;
9600 }
9601 }
9602
9603 return newlist;
9604 }
9605
9606
9607 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9608
9609 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9610 font table. */
9611
9612 static void
9613 x_check_font (f, font)
9614 struct frame *f;
9615 XFontStruct *font;
9616 {
9617 int i;
9618 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9619
9620 xassert (font != NULL);
9621
9622 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9623 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9624 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
9625 break;
9626
9627 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
9628 }
9629
9630 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9631
9632 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
9633 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
9634 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
9635 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
9636 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
9637
9638 static INLINE void
9639 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
9640 XFontStruct *font;
9641 int *w, *h;
9642 {
9643 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9644 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
9645
9646 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
9647 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
9648 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
9649 if (*w <= 0)
9650 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
9651 }
9652
9653
9654 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
9655 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
9656 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
9657 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
9658 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
9659
9660 static int
9661 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
9662 struct frame *f;
9663 {
9664 int i;
9665 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9666 XFontStruct *font;
9667 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
9668 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
9669
9670 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
9671 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
9672
9673 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9674 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
9675 {
9676 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9677 int w, h;
9678
9679 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
9680 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
9681 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
9682
9683 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
9684 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
9685 }
9686
9687 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
9688 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
9689
9690 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
9691 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
9692 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
9693 }
9694
9695
9696 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
9697 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
9698 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
9699 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
9700
9701 struct font_info *
9702 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
9703 struct frame *f;
9704 register char *fontname;
9705 int size;
9706 {
9707 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9708 Lisp_Object font_names;
9709
9710 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
9711 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
9712 we already have by comparing names. */
9713 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
9714
9715 if (!NILP (font_names))
9716 {
9717 Lisp_Object tail;
9718 int i;
9719
9720 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9721 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
9722 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9723 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
9724 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
9725 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
9726 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
9727 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9728 }
9729
9730 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
9731 {
9732 char *full_name;
9733 XFontStruct *font;
9734 struct font_info *fontp;
9735 unsigned long value;
9736 int i;
9737
9738 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
9739 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
9740 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
9741 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
9742 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
9743 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
9744 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
9745
9746 BLOCK_INPUT;
9747 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9748 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
9749 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
9750 {
9751 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9752 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9753 font = NULL;
9754 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9755 }
9756 x_uncatch_errors ();
9757 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9758 if (!font)
9759 return NULL;
9760
9761 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
9762 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9763 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
9764 break;
9765
9766 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
9767 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
9768 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
9769 {
9770 int sz;
9771 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
9772 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
9773 dpyinfo->font_table
9774 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
9775 }
9776
9777 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9778 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
9779 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
9780
9781 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
9782 BLOCK_INPUT;
9783 bzero (fontp, sizeof (*fontp));
9784 fontp->font = font;
9785 fontp->font_idx = i;
9786 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
9787 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
9788
9789 if (font->min_bounds.width == font->max_bounds.width)
9790 {
9791 /* Fixed width font. */
9792 fontp->average_width = fontp->space_width = font->min_bounds.width;
9793 }
9794 else
9795 {
9796 XChar2b char2b;
9797 XCharStruct *pcm;
9798
9799 char2b.byte1 = 0x00, char2b.byte2 = 0x20;
9800 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0);
9801 if (pcm)
9802 fontp->space_width = pcm->width;
9803 else
9804 fontp->space_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
9805
9806 fontp->average_width
9807 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH, &value)
9808 ? (long) value / 10 : 0);
9809 if (fontp->average_width < 0)
9810 fontp->average_width = - fontp->average_width;
9811 if (fontp->average_width == 0)
9812 {
9813 if (pcm)
9814 {
9815 int width = pcm->width;
9816 for (char2b.byte2 = 33; char2b.byte2 <= 126; char2b.byte2++)
9817 if ((pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0)) != NULL)
9818 width += pcm->width;
9819 fontp->average_width = width / 95;
9820 }
9821 else
9822 fontp->average_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
9823 }
9824 }
9825
9826 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
9827 full_name = 0;
9828 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9829 {
9830 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
9831 char *p = name;
9832 int dashes = 0;
9833
9834 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
9835 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
9836 so don't use it.
9837 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
9838 stored in them. */
9839 while (*p)
9840 {
9841 if (*p == '-')
9842 dashes++;
9843 p++;
9844 }
9845
9846 if (dashes >= 13)
9847 {
9848 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
9849 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
9850 }
9851
9852 XFree (name);
9853 }
9854
9855 if (full_name != 0)
9856 fontp->full_name = full_name;
9857 else
9858 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
9859
9860 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
9861 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9862
9863 if (NILP (font_names))
9864 {
9865 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
9866 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
9867 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
9868 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
9869 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
9870 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
9871 Qnil);
9872
9873 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9874 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9875 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9876 make_number (fontp->size)),
9877 Qnil)),
9878 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9879 if (full_name)
9880 {
9881 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
9882 Qnil);
9883 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9884 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9885 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9886 make_number (fontp->size)),
9887 Qnil)),
9888 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9889 }
9890 }
9891
9892 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
9893 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
9894 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
9895 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
9896 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
9897 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
9898 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
9899 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
9900 fontp->encoding[1]
9901 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
9902 /* 1-byte font */
9903 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9904 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9905 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
9906 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
9907 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
9908 /* 2-byte font */
9909 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
9910 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
9911 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9912 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9913 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
9914 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
9915 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
9916 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
9917 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9918 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9919 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
9920 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
9921 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
9922
9923 fontp->baseline_offset
9924 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
9925 ? (long) value : 0);
9926 fontp->relative_compose
9927 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
9928 ? (long) value : 0);
9929 fontp->default_ascent
9930 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
9931 ? (long) value : 0);
9932
9933 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
9934 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
9935 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
9936 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
9937 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
9938 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
9939 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9940 return fontp;
9941 }
9942 }
9943
9944
9945 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
9946 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
9947
9948 struct font_info *
9949 x_query_font (f, fontname)
9950 struct frame *f;
9951 register char *fontname;
9952 {
9953 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9954 int i;
9955
9956 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9957 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9958 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
9959 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
9960 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9961 return NULL;
9962 }
9963
9964
9965 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
9966 `encoder' of the structure. */
9967
9968 void
9969 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
9970 struct font_info *fontp;
9971 {
9972 Lisp_Object list, elt;
9973
9974 elt = Qnil;
9975 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9976 {
9977 elt = XCAR (list);
9978 if (CONSP (elt)
9979 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
9980 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
9981 >= 0)
9982 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
9983 >= 0)))
9984 break;
9985 }
9986
9987 if (! NILP (list))
9988 {
9989 struct ccl_program *ccl
9990 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
9991
9992 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
9993 xfree (ccl);
9994 else
9995 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
9996 }
9997 }
9998
9999
10000 \f
10001 /***********************************************************************
10002 Initialization
10003 ***********************************************************************/
10004
10005 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10006 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
10007 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10008 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
10009
10010 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
10011 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10012 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10013
10014 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10015 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10016 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10017 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10018 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10019 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10020 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
10021 };
10022 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10023
10024 static int x_initialized;
10025
10026 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10027 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10028 the screen number from the server number. */
10029 static int
10030 same_x_server (name1, name2)
10031 const char *name1, *name2;
10032 {
10033 int seen_colon = 0;
10034 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
10035 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
10036 int length_until_period = 0;
10037
10038 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
10039 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
10040 length_until_period++;
10041
10042 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10043 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10044 name1 += 4;
10045 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10046 name2 += 4;
10047 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10048 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10049 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10050 name1 += system_name_length;
10051 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10052 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
10053 name2 += system_name_length;
10054 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10055 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
10056 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
10057 name1 += length_until_period;
10058 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
10059 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
10060 name2 += length_until_period;
10061
10062 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
10063 {
10064 if (*name1 == ':')
10065 seen_colon++;
10066 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
10067 return 1;
10068 }
10069 return (seen_colon
10070 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
10071 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
10072 }
10073 #endif
10074
10075 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
10076 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
10077 to 5. */
10078 static void
10079 get_bits_and_offset (mask, bits, offset)
10080 unsigned long mask;
10081 int *bits;
10082 int *offset;
10083 {
10084 int nr = 0;
10085 int off = 0;
10086
10087 while (!(mask & 1))
10088 {
10089 off++;
10090 mask >>= 1;
10091 }
10092
10093 while (mask & 1)
10094 {
10095 nr++;
10096 mask >>= 1;
10097 }
10098
10099 *offset = off;
10100 *bits = nr;
10101 }
10102
10103 struct x_display_info *
10104 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
10105 Lisp_Object display_name;
10106 char *xrm_option;
10107 char *resource_name;
10108 {
10109 int connection;
10110 Display *dpy;
10111 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10112 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10113
10114 BLOCK_INPUT;
10115
10116 if (!x_initialized)
10117 {
10118 x_initialize ();
10119 ++x_initialized;
10120 }
10121
10122 #ifdef USE_GTK
10123 {
10124 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10125 int argc;
10126 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10127 char **argv2 = argv;
10128 GdkAtom atom;
10129
10130 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
10131 {
10132 /* Opening another display. If xg_display_open returns less
10133 than zero, we are probably on GTK 2.0, which can only handle
10134 one display. GTK 2.2 or later can handle more than one. */
10135 if (xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy) < 0)
10136 error ("Sorry, this version of GTK can only handle one display");
10137 }
10138 else
10139 {
10140 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10141 argv[argc] = 0;
10142
10143 argc = 0;
10144 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10145
10146 if (! NILP (display_name))
10147 {
10148 argv[argc++] = "--display";
10149 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
10150 }
10151
10152 argv[argc++] = "--name";
10153 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10154
10155 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10156 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10157 #endif
10158
10159 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10160
10161 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10162 fixup_locale ();
10163 xg_initialize ();
10164
10165 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
10166
10167 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
10168 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10169
10170 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10171 {
10172 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
10173 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10174 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10175
10176 GCPRO2 (s, abs_file);
10177 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
10178 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10179
10180 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10181 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
10182
10183 UNGCPRO;
10184 }
10185
10186 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10187 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10188 }
10189 }
10190 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10191 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10192 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10193 errors with X11R5:
10194 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10195 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10196 So let's not use it until R6. */
10197 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10198 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10199 #endif
10200
10201 {
10202 int argc = 0;
10203 char *argv[3];
10204
10205 argv[0] = "";
10206 argc = 1;
10207 if (xrm_option)
10208 {
10209 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10210 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10211 }
10212 turn_on_atimers (0);
10213 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
10214 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10215 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10216 &argc, argv);
10217 turn_on_atimers (1);
10218
10219 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10220 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10221 fixup_locale ();
10222 #endif
10223 }
10224
10225 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10226 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10227 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10228 #endif
10229 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10230 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10231 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10232
10233 /* Detect failure. */
10234 if (dpy == 0)
10235 {
10236 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10237 return 0;
10238 }
10239
10240 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10241
10242 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10243 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10244
10245 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10246 {
10247 struct x_display_info *share;
10248 Lisp_Object tail;
10249
10250 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10251 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10252 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10253 SDATA (display_name)))
10254 break;
10255 if (share)
10256 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
10257 else
10258 {
10259 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10260 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10261 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10262 {
10263 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10264 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10265 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10266 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10267 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
10268 BLOCK_INPUT;
10269 }
10270
10271 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10272 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
10273 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10274 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10275 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10276 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10277 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
10278 }
10279 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
10280 }
10281 #endif
10282
10283 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10284 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10285 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10286
10287 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10288 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10289 x_display_name_list);
10290 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10291
10292 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10293
10294 #if 0
10295 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10296 #endif /* ! 0 */
10297
10298 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10299 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10300 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10301 + 2);
10302 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10303 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10304
10305 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10306 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10307
10308 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10309 #ifdef USE_GTK
10310 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10311 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10312 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10313
10314 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10315 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10316
10317 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10318 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10319 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10320 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10321 #else
10322 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10323 #endif
10324 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10325 all versions. */
10326 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10327
10328 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10329 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10330 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10331 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10332 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10333 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10334 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10335 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10336 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10337 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10338 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10339 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
10340 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10341 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
10342 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10343 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10344 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10345 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10346 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10347 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10348 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10349 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10350 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10351 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10352 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10353 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10354 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10355 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10356 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10357 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10358 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10359 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
10360 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10361
10362 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10363 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10364 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10365
10366 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10367 {
10368 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10369 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10370 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10371 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10372 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10373 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10374 }
10375
10376 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10377 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10378 {
10379 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10380 {
10381 Lisp_Object value;
10382 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10383 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10384 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10385 Qnil, Qnil);
10386 if (STRINGP (value)
10387 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10388 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10389 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10390 }
10391 }
10392 else
10393 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10394 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10395
10396 {
10397 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10398 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10399 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10400 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10401 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10402 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10403 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10404 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10405 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10406 }
10407
10408 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10409 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10410 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10411 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10412 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10413 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10414 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10415 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10416 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10417 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10418 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10419 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10420 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10421 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10422 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10423 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
10424 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10425 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10426 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10427 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10428 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10429 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10430 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10431 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10432 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10433 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10434 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10435 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10436 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10437 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10438 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10439 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10440 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10441 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10442 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10443 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10444 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10445 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10446 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10447 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10448 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10449 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10450 /* For properties of font. */
10451 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10452 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10453 dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
10454 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "AVERAGE_WIDTH", False);
10455 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10456 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10457 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10458 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10459 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10460 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10461
10462 /* Ghostscript support. */
10463 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10464 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10465
10466 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10467 False);
10468
10469 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10470
10471 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10472 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10473
10474 {
10475 char null_bits[1];
10476
10477 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
10478
10479 dpyinfo->null_pixel
10480 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10481 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
10482 1);
10483 }
10484
10485 {
10486 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
10487 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
10488 dpyinfo->gray
10489 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10490 gray_bitmap_bits,
10491 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10492 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10493 }
10494
10495 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10496 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10497 #endif
10498
10499 #ifdef subprocesses
10500 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10501 if (connection != 0)
10502 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10503 #endif
10504
10505 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
10506 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10507 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
10508 /* stdin is a socket here */
10509 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
10510 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10511 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10512 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10513 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10514 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
10515
10516 #ifdef SIGIO
10517 if (interrupt_input)
10518 init_sigio (connection);
10519 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10520
10521 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10522 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
10523 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
10524 so that Xt does not crash. */
10525 {
10526 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10527 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10528 Font font;
10529
10530 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10531 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10532 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10533 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10534 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10535 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10536 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10537 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10538 abort ();
10539 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10540 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10541 x_uncatch_errors ();
10542 }
10543 #endif
10544 #endif
10545
10546 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10547 for debugging X code. */
10548 {
10549 Lisp_Object value;
10550 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10551 build_string ("synchronous"),
10552 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10553 Qnil, Qnil);
10554 if (STRINGP (value)
10555 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10556 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10557 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10558 }
10559
10560 {
10561 Lisp_Object value;
10562 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10563 build_string ("useXIM"),
10564 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10565 Qnil, Qnil);
10566 #ifdef USE_XIM
10567 if (STRINGP (value)
10568 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "false")
10569 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "off")))
10570 use_xim = 0;
10571 #else
10572 if (STRINGP (value)
10573 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
10574 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
10575 use_xim = 1;
10576 #endif
10577 }
10578
10579 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10580 /* Only do this for the first display. */
10581 if (x_initialized == 1)
10582 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10583 #endif
10584
10585 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10586
10587 return dpyinfo;
10588 }
10589 \f
10590 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
10591 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10592
10593 void
10594 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
10595 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10596 {
10597 int i;
10598
10599 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10600
10601 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10602 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10603 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10604 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10605 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10606 else
10607 {
10608 Lisp_Object tail;
10609
10610 tail = x_display_name_list;
10611 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10612 {
10613 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10614 {
10615 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10616 break;
10617 }
10618 tail = XCDR (tail);
10619 }
10620 }
10621
10622 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10623 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10624
10625 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10626 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10627 else
10628 {
10629 struct x_display_info *tail;
10630
10631 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10632 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10633 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10634 }
10635
10636 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
10637 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
10638 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10639 #endif
10640 #endif
10641 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10642 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
10643 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10644 #endif
10645 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10646 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10647 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10648 #endif
10649
10650 /* Free the font names in the font table. */
10651 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10652 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
10653 {
10654 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name != dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name)
10655 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name);
10656 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name);
10657 }
10658
10659 if (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder)
10660 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder);
10661
10662 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
10663 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10664 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10665 xfree (dpyinfo);
10666 }
10667
10668 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10669
10670 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10671 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10672 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10673 that slows us down. */
10674
10675 static void
10676 x_process_timeouts (timer)
10677 struct atimer *timer;
10678 {
10679 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10680 {
10681 BLOCK_INPUT;
10682 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10683 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10684 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10685 }
10686 }
10687
10688 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10689
10690 \f
10691 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10692
10693 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10694
10695 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10696 {
10697 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10698 x_produce_glyphs,
10699 x_write_glyphs,
10700 x_insert_glyphs,
10701 x_clear_end_of_line,
10702 x_scroll_run,
10703 x_after_update_window_line,
10704 x_update_window_begin,
10705 x_update_window_end,
10706 x_cursor_to,
10707 x_flush,
10708 #ifdef XFlush
10709 x_flush,
10710 #else
10711 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10712 #endif
10713 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10714 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10715 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10716 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10717 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10718 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10719 x_per_char_metric,
10720 x_encode_char,
10721 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10722 x_draw_glyph_string,
10723 x_define_frame_cursor,
10724 x_clear_frame_area,
10725 x_draw_window_cursor,
10726 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10727 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10728 };
10729
10730 void
10731 x_initialize ()
10732 {
10733 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10734
10735 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10736 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10737 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10738 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10739 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10740 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10741 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10742 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10743 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10744 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10745 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10746 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10747 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10748 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10749 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10750 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10751 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10752 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10753
10754 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
10755 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10756 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
10757 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
10758 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
10759 off the bottom */
10760 baud_rate = 19200;
10761
10762 x_noop_count = 0;
10763 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10764 any_help_event_p = 0;
10765 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10766
10767 #ifdef USE_GTK
10768 current_count = -1;
10769 #endif
10770
10771 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10772 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
10773
10774 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10775 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10776
10777 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10778
10779 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10780 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10781 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10782 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10783 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10784 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10785 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10786
10787 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10788
10789 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10790 every 0.1s. This is necessary because some widget sets use
10791 timeouts internally, for example the LessTif menu bar, or the
10792 Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timouts aren't processed, these
10793 widgets don't behave normally. */
10794 {
10795 EMACS_TIME interval;
10796 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10797 start_atimer (ATIMER_CONTINUOUS, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10798 }
10799 #endif
10800
10801 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10802 #ifndef USE_GTK
10803 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10804 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10805 #endif
10806 #endif
10807
10808 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10809 original error handler. */
10810 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10811 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10812
10813 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
10814 #ifdef SIGWINCH
10815 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
10816 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
10817
10818 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10819 }
10820
10821
10822 void
10823 syms_of_xterm ()
10824 {
10825 x_error_message = NULL;
10826
10827 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10828 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10829
10830 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10831 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10832
10833 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10834 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10835
10836 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
10837 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
10838 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10839 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
10840
10841 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10842 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10843
10844 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10845 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10846 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10847 nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10848 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10849 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
10850 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10851
10852 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10853 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10854 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10855 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10856 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10857 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10858 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10859 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10860 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10861
10862 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10863 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
10864 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
10865 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
10866 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10867 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10868 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
10869 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10870 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
10871 #elif USE_GTK
10872 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
10873 #else
10874 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
10875 #endif
10876 #else
10877 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10878 #endif
10879
10880 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10881 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10882
10883 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
10884 Qalt = intern ("alt");
10885 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10886 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
10887 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10888 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
10889 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10890 Qsuper = intern ("super");
10891 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10892
10893 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10894 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10895 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10896 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10897 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10898 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10899
10900 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10901 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10902 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10903 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10904 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10905 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10906
10907 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10908 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10909 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10910 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10911 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10912 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10913
10914 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10915 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10916 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10917 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10918 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10919 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10920
10921 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10922 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10923 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10924 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10925 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10926 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10927 }
10928
10929 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
10930
10931 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
10932 (do not change this comment) */